1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4 *
5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6 * Copyright 2006-2007 Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7 * Copyright 2007-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2022 Intel Corporation
11 */
12
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23 #include <net/codel.h>
24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25 #include <asm/unaligned.h>
26
27 /**
28 * DOC: Introduction
29 *
30 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33 * drivers.
34 */
35
36 /**
37 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38 *
39 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44 * tasklet function.
45 *
46 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47 * use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48 */
49
50 /**
51 * DOC: Warning
52 *
53 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55 */
56
57 /**
58 * DOC: Frame format
59 *
60 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63 * hardware.
64 *
65 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66 *
67 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69 *
70 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72 */
73
74 /**
75 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76 *
77 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81 *
82 * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83 * suspend.
84 *
85 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86 *
87 */
88
89 /**
90 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91 *
92 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94 * different stations/interfaces.
95 *
96 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98 * handler.
99 *
100 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103 *
104 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106 *
107 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109 * driver op.
110 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113 *
114 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118 * ieee80211_return_txq().
119 *
120 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124 * .release_buffered_frames().
125 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128 */
129
130 /**
131 * DOC: HW timestamping
132 *
133 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135 *
136 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139 * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140 *
141 * Similarly, To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144 * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145 */
146 struct device;
147
148 /**
149 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150 *
151 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153 */
154 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES = 16,
156 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP = BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157 };
158
159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 0xff
160
161 /**
162 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167 */
168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169 IEEE80211_AC_VO = 0,
170 IEEE80211_AC_VI = 1,
171 IEEE80211_AC_BE = 2,
172 IEEE80211_AC_BK = 3,
173 };
174
175 /**
176 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177 *
178 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180 *
181 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190 */
191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192 u16 txop;
193 u16 cw_min;
194 u16 cw_max;
195 u8 aifs;
196 bool acm;
197 bool uapsd;
198 bool mu_edca;
199 struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200 };
201
202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203 unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204 unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205 unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206 unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207 };
208
209 /**
210 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215 * this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
217 */
218 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
219 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH = BIT(0),
220 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS = BIT(1),
221 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR = BIT(2),
222 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(3),
223 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH = BIT(4),
224 };
225
226 /**
227 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
228 *
229 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
230 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
231 *
232 * @def: the channel definition
233 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
234 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
235 * active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
236 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
237 * after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
238 * this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
239 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
240 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
241 * sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
242 */
243 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
244 struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
245 struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
246
247 u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
248
249 bool radar_enabled;
250
251 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
252 };
253
254 /**
255 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
256 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
257 * exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
258 * needs to be switched from one to the other.
259 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
260 * to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
261 * will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
262 * from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
263 * implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
264 * hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
265 * will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
266 * for changes/removal.)
267 */
268 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
269 CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
270 CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
271 };
272
273 /**
274 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
275 *
276 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
277 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another. The
278 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
279 * done.
280 *
281 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
282 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
283 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
284 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
285 */
286 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
287 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
288 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
289 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
290 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
291 };
292
293 /**
294 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
295 *
296 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
297 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
298 *
299 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
300 * also implies a change in the AID.
301 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
302 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
303 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
304 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
305 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
306 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
307 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
308 * reason (IBSS and managed mode)
309 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
310 * new beacon (beaconing modes)
311 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
312 * enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
313 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
314 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
315 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
316 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
317 * that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
318 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
319 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
320 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
321 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
322 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
323 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
324 * changed
325 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
326 * currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
327 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
328 * note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
329 * context had been assigned.
330 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
331 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
332 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
333 * keep alive) changed.
334 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
335 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
336 * functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
337 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
338 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
339 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
340 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
341 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
342 * status changed.
343 * @BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING: The channel puncturing bitmap changed.
344 */
345 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
346 BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC = 1<<0,
347 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT = 1<<1,
348 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE = 1<<2,
349 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT = 1<<3,
350 BSS_CHANGED_HT = 1<<4,
351 BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES = 1<<5,
352 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT = 1<<6,
353 BSS_CHANGED_BSSID = 1<<7,
354 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON = 1<<8,
355 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED = 1<<9,
356 BSS_CHANGED_CQM = 1<<10,
357 BSS_CHANGED_IBSS = 1<<11,
358 BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER = 1<<12,
359 BSS_CHANGED_QOS = 1<<13,
360 BSS_CHANGED_IDLE = 1<<14,
361 BSS_CHANGED_SSID = 1<<15,
362 BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP = 1<<16,
363 BSS_CHANGED_PS = 1<<17,
364 BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER = 1<<18,
365 BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS = 1<<19,
366 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO = 1<<20,
367 BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH = 1<<21,
368 BSS_CHANGED_OCB = 1<<22,
369 BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS = 1<<23,
370 BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE = 1<<24,
371 BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE = 1<<25,
372 BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER = 1<<26,
373 BSS_CHANGED_TWT = 1<<27,
374 BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD = 1<<28,
375 BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR = 1<<29,
376 BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY = 1<<30,
377 BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31,
378 BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING = BIT_ULL(32),
379
380 /* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
381 };
382
383 /*
384 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
385 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
386 * filtering will be disabled.
387 */
388 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
389
390 /**
391 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
392 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
393 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
394 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
395 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
396 * they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
397 * once each time the timeout triggers.
398 */
399 enum ieee80211_event_type {
400 RSSI_EVENT,
401 MLME_EVENT,
402 BAR_RX_EVENT,
403 BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
404 };
405
406 /**
407 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
408 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
409 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
410 */
411 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
412 RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
413 RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
414 };
415
416 /**
417 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
418 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
419 */
420 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
421 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
422 };
423
424 /**
425 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
426 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
427 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
428 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
429 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
430 */
431 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
432 AUTH_EVENT,
433 ASSOC_EVENT,
434 DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
435 DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
436 };
437
438 /**
439 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
440 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
441 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
442 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
443 */
444 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
445 MLME_SUCCESS,
446 MLME_DENIED,
447 MLME_TIMEOUT,
448 };
449
450 /**
451 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
452 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
453 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
454 * @reason: the reason code if applicable
455 */
456 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
457 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
458 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
459 u16 reason;
460 };
461
462 /**
463 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
464 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
465 * @tid: the tid
466 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
467 */
468 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
469 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
470 u16 tid;
471 u16 ssn;
472 };
473
474 /**
475 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
476 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
477 * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
478 * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
479 * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
480 * @u:union holding the fields above
481 */
482 struct ieee80211_event {
483 enum ieee80211_event_type type;
484 union {
485 struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
486 struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
487 struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
488 } u;
489 };
490
491 /**
492 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
493 *
494 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
495 *
496 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
497 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
498 */
499 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
500 u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
501 u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
502 };
503
504 /**
505 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
506 *
507 * @lci: LCI subelement content
508 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
509 * @lci_len: LCI data length
510 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
511 */
512 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
513 const u8 *lci;
514 const u8 *civicloc;
515 size_t lci_len;
516 size_t civicloc_len;
517 };
518
519 /**
520 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
521 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
522 *
523 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
524 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
525 */
526 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
527 u32 min_interval;
528 u32 max_interval;
529 };
530
531 /**
532 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
533 *
534 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
535 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
536 *
537 * @addr: (link) address used locally
538 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
539 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
540 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
541 * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either
542 * ACK, BACK or both
543 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
544 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
545 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
546 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
547 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
548 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
549 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
550 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
551 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
552 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
553 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
554 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
555 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
556 * valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
557 * with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
558 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
559 * as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
560 * HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
561 * only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
562 * association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
563 * %BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
564 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
565 * the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
566 * (see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
567 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
568 * is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
569 * IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
570 * by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
571 * guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
572 * Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
573 * know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
574 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
575 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
576 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
577 * index into the rate table configured by the driver in
578 * the current band.
579 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
580 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
581 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
582 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
583 * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be
584 * configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
585 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
586 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
587 * This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
588 * Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
589 * be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
590 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
591 * implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
592 * cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
593 * relation to the newly configured threshold.
594 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
595 * implies disabled. This is an alternative mechanism to the single
596 * threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
597 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
598 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
599 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
600 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
601 * @txpower: TX power in dBm. INT_MIN means not configured.
602 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
603 * Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
604 * TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
605 * NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
606 * userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
607 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
608 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
609 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
610 * to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
611 * if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
612 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
613 * transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
614 * In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
615 * a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
616 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
617 * protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
618 * station.
619 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
620 * responder functionality.
621 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
622 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
623 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
624 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
625 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
626 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
627 * nontransmitted BSSIDs
628 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
629 * in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
630 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
631 * connected to (STA)
632 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
633 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
634 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
635 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
636 * interval.
637 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
638 * to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
639 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
640 * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS.
641 * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env.
642 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
643 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
644 * @eht_puncturing: bitmap to indicate which channels are punctured in this BSS
645 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is
646 * write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
647 * for read access.
648 * @csa_punct_bitmap: new puncturing bitmap for channel switch
649 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
650 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
651 * when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
652 * path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
653 * be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
654 * processed after it switches back to %NULL.
655 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing. Internally it is
656 * write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
657 * for read access.
658 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
659 * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
660 * beamformer
661 * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
662 * beamformee
663 * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
664 * beamformer
665 * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
666 * beamformee
667 * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
668 * beamformer
669 * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
670 * beamformee
671 * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
672 * beamformer
673 * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
674 * (non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
675 * bandwidth
676 */
677 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
678 const u8 *bssid;
679 unsigned int link_id;
680 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
681 u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
682 bool uora_exists;
683 u8 uora_ocw_range;
684 u16 frame_time_rts_th;
685 bool he_support;
686 bool twt_requester;
687 bool twt_responder;
688 bool twt_protected;
689 bool twt_broadcast;
690 /* erp related data */
691 bool use_cts_prot;
692 bool use_short_preamble;
693 bool use_short_slot;
694 bool enable_beacon;
695 u8 dtim_period;
696 u16 beacon_int;
697 u16 assoc_capability;
698 u64 sync_tsf;
699 u32 sync_device_ts;
700 u8 sync_dtim_count;
701 u32 basic_rates;
702 struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
703 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
704 u16 ht_operation_mode;
705 s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
706 u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
707 s32 cqm_rssi_low;
708 s32 cqm_rssi_high;
709 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
710 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
711 bool qos;
712 bool hidden_ssid;
713 int txpower;
714 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
715 struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
716 bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
717 u16 max_idle_period;
718 bool protected_keep_alive;
719 bool ftm_responder;
720 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
721 /* Multiple BSSID data */
722 bool nontransmitted;
723 u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
724 u8 bssid_index;
725 u8 bssid_indicator;
726 bool ema_ap;
727 u8 profile_periodicity;
728 struct {
729 u32 params;
730 u16 nss_set;
731 } he_oper;
732 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
733 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
734 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
735 u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
736 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
737 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
738 struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT];
739 u8 tx_pwr_env_num;
740 u8 pwr_reduction;
741 bool eht_support;
742 u16 eht_puncturing;
743
744 bool csa_active;
745 u16 csa_punct_bitmap;
746
747 bool mu_mimo_owner;
748 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
749
750 bool color_change_active;
751 u8 color_change_color;
752
753 bool vht_su_beamformer;
754 bool vht_su_beamformee;
755 bool vht_mu_beamformer;
756 bool vht_mu_beamformee;
757 bool he_su_beamformer;
758 bool he_su_beamformee;
759 bool he_mu_beamformer;
760 bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
761 };
762
763 /**
764 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
765 *
766 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
767 *
768 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
769 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
770 * number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
771 * number and increasing the sequence number only when the
772 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
773 * assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
774 * for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
775 * that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
776 * If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
777 * assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
778 * 802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
779 * beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
780 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
781 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
782 * station
783 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
784 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
785 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
786 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
787 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
788 * because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
789 * avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
790 * firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
791 * went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
792 * the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
793 * that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
794 * since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
795 * hardware queue.
796 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
797 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
798 * is for the whole aggregation.
799 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
800 * so consider using block ack request (BAR).
801 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
802 * set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
803 * be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
804 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
805 * that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
806 * off-channel operation.
807 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
808 * (header conversion)
809 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
810 * used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
811 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
812 * used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
813 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
814 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
815 * be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
816 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
817 * transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
818 * by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
819 * queue gets full.
820 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
821 * after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
822 * be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
823 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
824 * code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
825 * should kick the MLME state machine.
826 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
827 * MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
828 * status to user space)
829 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
830 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
831 * frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
832 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
833 * the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
834 * in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
835 * handled properly by the device.
836 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
837 * testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
838 * TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
839 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
840 * This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
841 * frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
842 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
843 * when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
844 * an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
845 * the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
846 * PS-Poll responses.
847 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
848 * This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
849 * the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
850 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
851 * would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
852 * monitor injection).
853 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
854 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
855 * any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
856 * This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
857 * behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
858 *
859 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
860 * forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
861 */
862 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
863 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS = BIT(0),
864 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ = BIT(1),
865 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK = BIT(2),
866 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT = BIT(3),
867 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT = BIT(4),
868 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM = BIT(5),
869 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU = BIT(6),
870 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED = BIT(7),
871 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED = BIT(8),
872 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK = BIT(9),
873 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU = BIT(10),
874 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK = BIT(11),
875 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE = BIT(12),
876 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK = BIT(13),
877 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP = BIT(14),
878 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED = BIT(15),
879 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT = BIT(16),
880 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER = BIT(17),
881 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES = BIT(18),
882 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION = BIT(19),
883 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX = BIT(20),
884 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX = BIT(21),
885 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC = BIT(22),
886 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC = BIT(23) | BIT(24),
887 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN = BIT(25),
888 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE = BIT(26),
889 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE = BIT(27),
890 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP = BIT(28),
891 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE = BIT(29),
892 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG = BIT(30),
893 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED = BIT(31),
894 };
895
896 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT 23
897
898 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
899
900 /**
901 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
902 *
903 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
904 * protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
905 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
906 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
907 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
908 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
909 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
910 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
911 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
912 * used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
913 * it can be sent out.
914 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
915 * has already been assigned to this frame.
916 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
917 * relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
918 * of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
919 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
920 * for sequence number assignment
921 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
922 * frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
923 * only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
924 * also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
925 * is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
926 * it's intended for an MLD.
927 *
928 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
929 */
930 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
931 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO = BIT(0),
932 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE = BIT(1),
933 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT = BIT(2),
934 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU = BIT(3),
935 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT = BIT(4),
936 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP = BIT(5),
937 IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING = BIT(6),
938 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO = BIT(7),
939 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER = BIT(8),
940 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX = BIT(9),
941 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK = 0xf0000000,
942 };
943
944 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED 0xf
945 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC \
946 u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
947 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
948
949 /**
950 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
951 *
952 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
953 *
954 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
955 */
956 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
957 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
958 };
959
960 /*
961 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
962 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
963 */
964 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK | \
965 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT | \
966 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU | \
967 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK | \
968 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK | \
969 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER | \
970 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC | \
971 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
972
973 /**
974 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
975 * Rate Control algorithm.
976 *
977 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
978 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
979 *
980 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
981 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
982 * This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
983 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
984 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
985 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
986 * into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
987 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
988 * Greenfield mode.
989 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
990 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
991 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
992 * (80+80 isn't supported yet)
993 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
994 * adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
995 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
996 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
997 */
998 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
999 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS = BIT(0),
1000 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT = BIT(1),
1001 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(2),
1002
1003 /* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1004 IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS = BIT(3),
1005 IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD = BIT(4),
1006 IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(5),
1007 IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA = BIT(6),
1008 IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI = BIT(7),
1009 IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS = BIT(8),
1010 IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(9),
1011 IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(10),
1012 };
1013
1014
1015 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1016 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1017
1018 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1019 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1020
1021 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1022 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES 4
1023
1024 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1025 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE 4
1026
1027 /**
1028 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1029 *
1030 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1031 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1032 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1033 *
1034 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1035 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1036 *
1037 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1038 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1039 *
1040 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1041 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1042 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1043 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1044 * information::
1045 *
1046 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1047 *
1048 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1049 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1050 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1051 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1052 * information should then contain::
1053 *
1054 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1055 *
1056 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1057 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1058 */
1059 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1060 s8 idx;
1061 u16 count:5,
1062 flags:11;
1063 } __packed;
1064
1065 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY 31
1066
ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate,u8 mcs,u8 nss)1067 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1068 u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1069 {
1070 WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1071 WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1072 rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1073 }
1074
1075 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1076 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1077 {
1078 return rate->idx & 0xF;
1079 }
1080
1081 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1082 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1083 {
1084 return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1085 }
1086
1087 /**
1088 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1089 *
1090 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1091 * (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1092 * (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1093 * (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1094 *
1095 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1096 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1097 * not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1098 * link the frame will be transmitted on
1099 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1100 * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally
1101 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1102 * @control: union part for control data
1103 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1104 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1105 * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1106 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1107 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1108 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1109 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1110 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1111 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1112 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1113 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1114 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1115 * @pad: padding
1116 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1117 * @status: union part for status data
1118 * @status.rates: attempted rates
1119 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1120 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1121 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1122 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1123 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1124 * used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1125 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1126 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1127 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1128 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1129 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1130 * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames.
1131 * relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1132 * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames.
1133 * relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1134 * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame
1135 */
1136 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1137 /* common information */
1138 u32 flags;
1139 u32 band:3,
1140 ack_frame_id:13,
1141 hw_queue:4,
1142 tx_time_est:10;
1143 /* 2 free bits */
1144
1145 union {
1146 struct {
1147 union {
1148 /* rate control */
1149 struct {
1150 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1151 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1152 s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1153 u8 use_rts:1;
1154 u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1155 u8 short_preamble:1;
1156 u8 skip_table:1;
1157 /* 2 bytes free */
1158 };
1159 /* only needed before rate control */
1160 unsigned long jiffies;
1161 };
1162 /* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1163 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1164 struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1165 u32 flags;
1166 codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1167 } control;
1168 struct {
1169 u64 cookie;
1170 } ack;
1171 struct {
1172 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1173 s32 ack_signal;
1174 u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1175 u8 ampdu_len;
1176 u8 antenna;
1177 u16 tx_time;
1178 u8 flags;
1179 void *status_driver_data[18 / sizeof(void *)];
1180 } status;
1181 struct {
1182 struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1183 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1184 u8 pad[4];
1185
1186 void *rate_driver_data[
1187 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1188 };
1189 void *driver_data[
1190 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1191 };
1192 };
1193
1194 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info,u16 tx_time_est)1195 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1196 {
1197 /* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1198 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1199 */
1200 info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1201 return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1202 }
1203
1204 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1205 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1206 {
1207 return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1208 }
1209
1210 /***
1211 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1212 *
1213 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1214 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1215 *
1216 * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1217 * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1218 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1219 * corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1220 * that was used when sending the packet.
1221 */
1222 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1223 struct rate_info rate_idx;
1224 u8 try_count;
1225 u8 tx_power_idx;
1226 };
1227
1228 /**
1229 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1230 *
1231 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1232 * @info: Basic tx status information
1233 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1234 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1235 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1236 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1237 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1238 * Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1239 * frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1240 */
1241 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1242 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1243 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1244 struct sk_buff *skb;
1245 struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1246 ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1247 u8 n_rates;
1248
1249 struct list_head *free_list;
1250 };
1251
1252 /**
1253 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1254 *
1255 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1256 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1257 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1258 *
1259 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1260 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1261 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1262 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1263 */
1264 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1265 const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1266 size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1267 const u8 *common_ies;
1268 size_t common_ie_len;
1269 };
1270
1271
IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff * skb)1272 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1273 {
1274 return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1275 }
1276
IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff * skb)1277 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1278 {
1279 return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1280 }
1281
1282 /**
1283 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1284 *
1285 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1286 *
1287 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1288 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1289 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1290 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1291 *
1292 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1293 * driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1294 * any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1295 */
1296 static inline void
ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1297 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1298 {
1299 int i;
1300
1301 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1302 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1303 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1304 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1305 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1306 /* clear the rate counts */
1307 for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1308 info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1309 memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1310 }
1311
1312
1313 /**
1314 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1315 *
1316 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1317 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1318 * Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1319 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1320 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1321 * verification has been done by the hardware.
1322 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1323 * If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1324 * hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1325 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1326 * flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1327 * Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1328 * is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1329 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1330 * de-duplication by itself.
1331 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1332 * the frame.
1333 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1334 * the frame.
1335 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1336 * field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1337 * was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1338 * merging.
1339 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1340 * field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1341 * (including FCS) was received.
1342 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1343 * field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1344 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1345 * Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1346 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1347 * number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1348 * each A-MPDU
1349 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1350 * subframes of a single A-MPDU
1351 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1352 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1353 * on this subframe
1354 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1355 * is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1356 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1357 * done by the hardware
1358 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1359 * processing it in any regular way.
1360 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1361 * them for sniffing purposes.
1362 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1363 * monitor interfaces.
1364 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1365 * them for sniffing purposes.
1366 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1367 * subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1368 * All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1369 * if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1370 * the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1371 * deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1372 * subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1373 * either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1374 * interleaved with other frames.
1375 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA: This frame contains vendor-specific
1376 * radiotap data in the skb->data (before the frame) as described by
1377 * the &struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap.
1378 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1379 * This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1380 * the first subframe.
1381 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1382 * be done in the hardware.
1383 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1384 * frame
1385 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1386 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1387 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1388 *
1389 * - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1390 * - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1391 * - DATA3_CODING
1392 * - DATA5_GI
1393 * - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1394 * - DATA6_NSTS
1395 * - DATA3_STBC
1396 *
1397 * from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1398 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1399 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1400 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1401 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1402 * the "0-length PSDU" field included there. The value for it is
1403 * in &struct ieee80211_rx_status. Note that if this value isn't
1404 * known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1405 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1406 * hardware or driver)
1407 */
1408 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1409 RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR = BIT(0),
1410 RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED = BIT(1),
1411 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START = BIT(2),
1412 RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED = BIT(3),
1413 RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED = BIT(4),
1414 RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC = BIT(5),
1415 RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC = BIT(6),
1416 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START = BIT(7),
1417 RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL = BIT(8),
1418 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS = BIT(9),
1419 RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED = BIT(10),
1420 RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED = BIT(11),
1421 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN = BIT(12),
1422 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST = BIT(13),
1423 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR = BIT(14),
1424 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN = BIT(15),
1425 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END = BIT(16),
1426 RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR = BIT(17),
1427 RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR = BIT(18),
1428 RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE = BIT(19),
1429 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA = BIT(20),
1430 RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED = BIT(21),
1431 RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN = BIT(22),
1432 RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED = BIT(23),
1433 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT = BIT(24),
1434 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN = BIT(25),
1435 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE = BIT(26),
1436 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU = BIT(27),
1437 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG = BIT(28),
1438 RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU = BIT(29),
1439 RX_FLAG_8023 = BIT(30),
1440 };
1441
1442 /**
1443 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1444 *
1445 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1446 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1447 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1448 * if the driver fills this value it should add
1449 * %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1450 * to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1451 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1452 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1453 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1454 */
1455 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1456 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE = BIT(0),
1457 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI = BIT(2),
1458 RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF = BIT(3),
1459 RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK = BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1460 RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC = BIT(6),
1461 RX_ENC_FLAG_BF = BIT(7),
1462 };
1463
1464 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT 4
1465
1466 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1467 RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1468 RX_ENC_HT,
1469 RX_ENC_VHT,
1470 RX_ENC_HE,
1471 RX_ENC_EHT,
1472 };
1473
1474 /**
1475 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1476 *
1477 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1478 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1479 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1480 *
1481 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1482 * (TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1483 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1484 * needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1485 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1486 * needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1487 * Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1488 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1489 * it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1490 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1491 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1492 * This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1493 * for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1494 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1495 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1496 * unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1497 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1498 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1499 * values were filled.
1500 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1501 * support dB or unspecified units)
1502 * @antenna: antenna used
1503 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1504 * HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1505 * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1506 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1507 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1508 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1509 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1510 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1511 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1512 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1513 * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1514 * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1515 * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1516 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1517 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1518 * each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1519 * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1520 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1521 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1522 * is set only when connection is MLO.
1523 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1524 * @link_valid.
1525 */
1526 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1527 u64 mactime;
1528 union {
1529 u64 boottime_ns;
1530 ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1531 };
1532 u32 device_timestamp;
1533 u32 ampdu_reference;
1534 u32 flag;
1535 u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1536 u8 enc_flags;
1537 u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1538 union {
1539 struct {
1540 u8 he_ru:3;
1541 u8 he_gi:2;
1542 u8 he_dcm:1;
1543 };
1544 struct {
1545 u8 ru:4;
1546 u8 gi:2;
1547 } eht;
1548 };
1549 u8 rate_idx;
1550 u8 nss;
1551 u8 rx_flags;
1552 u8 band;
1553 u8 antenna;
1554 s8 signal;
1555 u8 chains;
1556 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1557 u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1558 u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1559 u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1560 };
1561
1562 static inline u32
ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status * rx_status)1563 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1564 {
1565 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1566 (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1567 }
1568
1569 /**
1570 * struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap - vendor radiotap data information
1571 * @present: presence bitmap for this vendor namespace
1572 * (this could be extended in the future if any vendor needs more
1573 * bits, the radiotap spec does allow for that)
1574 * @align: radiotap vendor namespace alignment. This defines the needed
1575 * alignment for the @data field below, not for the vendor namespace
1576 * description itself (which has a fixed 2-byte alignment)
1577 * Must be a power of two, and be set to at least 1!
1578 * @oui: radiotap vendor namespace OUI
1579 * @subns: radiotap vendor sub namespace
1580 * @len: radiotap vendor sub namespace skip length, if alignment is done
1581 * then that's added to this, i.e. this is only the length of the
1582 * @data field.
1583 * @pad: number of bytes of padding after the @data, this exists so that
1584 * the skb data alignment can be preserved even if the data has odd
1585 * length
1586 * @data: the actual vendor namespace data
1587 *
1588 * This struct, including the vendor data, goes into the skb->data before
1589 * the 802.11 header. It's split up in mac80211 using the align/oui/subns
1590 * data.
1591 */
1592 struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap {
1593 u32 present;
1594 u8 align;
1595 u8 oui[3];
1596 u8 subns;
1597 u8 pad;
1598 u16 len;
1599 u8 data[];
1600 } __packed;
1601
1602 /**
1603 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1604 *
1605 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1606 *
1607 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1608 * to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1609 * or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1610 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1611 * This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1612 * meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1613 * transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1614 * Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1615 * driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1616 * for more.
1617 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1618 * the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1619 * may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1620 * be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1621 * it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1622 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1623 * operating channel.
1624 */
1625 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1626 IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR = (1<<0),
1627 IEEE80211_CONF_PS = (1<<1),
1628 IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE = (1<<2),
1629 IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL = (1<<3),
1630 };
1631
1632
1633 /**
1634 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1635 *
1636 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1637 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1638 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1639 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1640 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1641 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1642 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1643 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1644 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1645 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1646 */
1647 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1648 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS = BIT(1),
1649 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL = BIT(2),
1650 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR = BIT(3),
1651 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS = BIT(4),
1652 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER = BIT(5),
1653 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(6),
1654 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS = BIT(7),
1655 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE = BIT(8),
1656 };
1657
1658 /**
1659 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1660 *
1661 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1662 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1663 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1664 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1665 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1666 */
1667 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1668 IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1669 IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1670 IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1671 IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1672
1673 /* keep last */
1674 IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1675 };
1676
1677 /**
1678 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1679 *
1680 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1681 *
1682 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1683 *
1684 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1685 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1686 * in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1687 * has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1688 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1689 * powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1690 * the CONF_PS flag is set.
1691 *
1692 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1693 * value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1694 *
1695 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1696 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1697 *
1698 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1699 * (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1700 * but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1701 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1702 * frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1703 * number of transmissions not the number of retries
1704 *
1705 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1706 * %IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1707 * configured for an HT channel.
1708 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1709 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1710 */
1711 struct ieee80211_conf {
1712 u32 flags;
1713 int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1714
1715 u16 listen_interval;
1716 u8 ps_dtim_period;
1717
1718 u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1719
1720 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1721 bool radar_enabled;
1722 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1723 };
1724
1725 /**
1726 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1727 *
1728 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1729 * operation.
1730 *
1731 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1732 * Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1733 * announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1734 * the driver passed into mac80211.
1735 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1736 * rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1737 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1738 * scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1739 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1740 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1741 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1742 * current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1743 * channel, expressed in TU.
1744 */
1745 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1746 u64 timestamp;
1747 u32 device_timestamp;
1748 bool block_tx;
1749 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1750 u8 count;
1751 u32 delay;
1752 };
1753
1754 /**
1755 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1756 *
1757 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1758 * on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1759 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1760 * monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1761 * connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1762 * provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1763 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1764 * interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1765 * but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1766 * only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1767 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1768 * and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1769 * this is not pure P2P vif.
1770 */
1771 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1772 IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER = BIT(0),
1773 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI = BIT(1),
1774 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD = BIT(2),
1775 IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE = BIT(3),
1776 };
1777
1778
1779 /**
1780 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1781 *
1782 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1783 * The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1784 * It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1785 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1786 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1787 * The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1788 * mac80211.
1789 */
1790
1791 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1792 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED = BIT(0),
1793 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR = BIT(1),
1794 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED = BIT(2),
1795 };
1796
1797 /**
1798 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1799 * @assoc: association status
1800 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1801 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1802 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1803 * offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1804 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1805 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1806 * may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1807 * The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1808 * to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1809 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1810 * may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1811 * array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1812 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1813 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1814 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1815 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1816 * hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1817 * your driver/device needs to do.
1818 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1819 * (station mode only)
1820 */
1821 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1822 /* association related data */
1823 bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1824 bool ibss_creator;
1825 bool ps;
1826 u16 aid;
1827
1828 __be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1829 int arp_addr_cnt;
1830 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1831 size_t ssid_len;
1832 bool s1g;
1833 bool idle;
1834 u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1835 };
1836
1837 /**
1838 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1839 *
1840 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1841 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1842 *
1843 * @type: type of this virtual interface
1844 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1845 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1846 * or the BSS we're associated to
1847 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1848 * indexed by link ID
1849 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1850 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1851 * The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1852 * API calls meant for that purpose.
1853 * @addr: address of this interface
1854 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1855 * interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1856 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1857 * vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
1858 * can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
1859 * for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
1860 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1861 * these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1862 * or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1863 * at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1864 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1865 * These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1866 * .change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
1867 * within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
1868 * restrictions.
1869 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1870 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1871 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1872 * interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1873 * monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1874 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1875 * interface.
1876 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
1877 * for this interface.
1878 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1879 * sizeof(void \*).
1880 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
1881 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
1882 * &enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
1883 * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
1884 */
1885 struct ieee80211_vif {
1886 enum nl80211_iftype type;
1887 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
1888 struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1889 struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
1890 u16 valid_links, active_links;
1891 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1892 bool p2p;
1893
1894 u8 cab_queue;
1895 u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1896
1897 struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1898
1899 netdev_features_t netdev_features;
1900 u32 driver_flags;
1901 u32 offload_flags;
1902
1903 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1904 struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1905 #endif
1906
1907 bool probe_req_reg;
1908 bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
1909
1910 struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
1911
1912 /* must be last */
1913 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1914 };
1915
1916 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id) \
1917 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++) \
1918 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \
1919 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \
1920 (link = rcu_dereference((vif)->link_conf[link_id])))
1921
ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)1922 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1923 {
1924 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
1925 return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
1926 #endif
1927 return false;
1928 }
1929
1930 /**
1931 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
1932 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
1933 *
1934 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1935 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
1936 *
1937 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1938 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1939 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1940 */
1941 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
1942
1943 /**
1944 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
1945 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
1946 *
1947 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1948 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
1949 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
1950 */
1951 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1952
1953 /**
1954 * lockdep_vif_mutex_held - for lockdep checks on link poiners
1955 * @vif: the interface to check
1956 */
lockdep_vif_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)1957 static inline bool lockdep_vif_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1958 {
1959 return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->mtx);
1960 }
1961
1962 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id) \
1963 rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \
1964 lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif))
1965
1966 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id) \
1967 rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \
1968 lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif))
1969
1970 /**
1971 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
1972 *
1973 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
1974 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
1975 *
1976 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
1977 * driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
1978 * particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
1979 * will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
1980 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
1981 * the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
1982 * generation in software.
1983 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
1984 * that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
1985 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
1986 * CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
1987 * (MFP) to be done in software.
1988 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
1989 * if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
1990 * itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
1991 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
1992 * not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
1993 * MIC.
1994 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
1995 * management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
1996 * crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
1997 * properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
1998 * fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
1999 * RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2000 * %IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2001 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2002 * driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2003 * only for management frames (MFP).
2004 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2005 * driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2006 * be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2007 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2008 * a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2009 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2010 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2011 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2012 * for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number
2013 * generation only
2014 */
2015 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2016 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT = BIT(0),
2017 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV = BIT(1),
2018 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC = BIT(2),
2019 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE = BIT(3),
2020 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX = BIT(4),
2021 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE = BIT(5),
2022 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT = BIT(6),
2023 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM = BIT(7),
2024 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE = BIT(8),
2025 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX = BIT(9),
2026 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE = BIT(10),
2027 };
2028
2029 /**
2030 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2031 *
2032 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2033 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2034 *
2035 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2036 * wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2037 * encrypted in hardware.
2038 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2039 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2040 * needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2041 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2042 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
2043 * @keylen: key material length
2044 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2045 * data block:
2046 * - Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2047 * - Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2048 * - Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2049 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2050 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2051 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
2052 */
2053 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2054 atomic64_t tx_pn;
2055 u32 cipher;
2056 u8 icv_len;
2057 u8 iv_len;
2058 u8 hw_key_idx;
2059 s8 keyidx;
2060 u16 flags;
2061 s8 link_id;
2062 u8 keylen;
2063 u8 key[];
2064 };
2065
2066 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN 16
2067
2068 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2069 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2070
2071 /**
2072 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2073 *
2074 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2075 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2076 * reverse order than in packet)
2077 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2078 * reverse order than in packet)
2079 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2080 * reverse order than in packet)
2081 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2082 * reverse order than in packet)
2083 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2084 */
2085 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2086 union {
2087 struct {
2088 u32 iv32;
2089 u16 iv16;
2090 } tkip;
2091 struct {
2092 u8 pn[6];
2093 } ccmp;
2094 struct {
2095 u8 pn[6];
2096 } aes_cmac;
2097 struct {
2098 u8 pn[6];
2099 } aes_gmac;
2100 struct {
2101 u8 pn[6];
2102 } gcmp;
2103 struct {
2104 u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2105 u8 seq_len;
2106 } hw;
2107 };
2108 };
2109
2110 /**
2111 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2112 *
2113 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2114 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2115 *
2116 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2117 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2118 */
2119 enum set_key_cmd {
2120 SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2121 };
2122
2123 /**
2124 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2125 *
2126 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2127 * this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2128 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2129 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2130 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2131 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2132 */
2133 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2134 /* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2135 IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2136 IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2137 IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2138 IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2139 IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2140 };
2141
2142 /**
2143 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2144 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2145 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2146 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2147 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2148 * (including 80+80 MHz)
2149 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2150 *
2151 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2152 * correctly, the values must be sorted.
2153 */
2154 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2155 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2156 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2157 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2158 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2159 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2160 };
2161
2162 /**
2163 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2164 *
2165 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2166 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2167 * Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2168 */
2169 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2170 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2171 struct {
2172 s8 idx;
2173 u8 count;
2174 u8 count_cts;
2175 u8 count_rts;
2176 u16 flags;
2177 } rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2178 };
2179
2180 /**
2181 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2182 *
2183 * Used to configure txpower for station.
2184 *
2185 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2186 * to the STA.
2187 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2188 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2189 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2190 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2191 * per peer TPC.
2192 */
2193 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2194 s16 power;
2195 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2196 };
2197
2198 /**
2199 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2200 *
2201 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2202 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2203 *
2204 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2205 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2206 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2207 *
2208 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2209 * A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2210 * * If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2211 * size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2212 *
2213 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2214 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2215 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2216 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2217 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2218 */
2219 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2220 u16 max_amsdu_len;
2221
2222 u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2223 u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2224 };
2225
2226 /**
2227 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2228 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2229 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2230 *
2231 * @sta: reference to owning STA
2232 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2233 * in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2234 * from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2235 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2236 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2237 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2238 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2239 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2240 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2241 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2242 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2243 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2244 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2245 * station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2246 * notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2247 * the station moves to associated state.
2248 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2249 *
2250 */
2251 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2252 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2253
2254 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2255 u8 link_id;
2256 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2257
2258 u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2259 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2260 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2261 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2262 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2263 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2264
2265 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2266
2267 u8 rx_nss;
2268 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2269 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2270 };
2271
2272 /**
2273 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2274 *
2275 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2276 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2277 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2278 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2279 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2280 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2281 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2282 * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2283 *
2284 * @addr: MAC address
2285 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2286 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2287 * that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2288 * Can be modified by driver.
2289 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2290 * otherwise always false)
2291 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2292 * sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2293 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2294 * if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2295 * IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2296 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2297 * @rates: rate control selection table
2298 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2299 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2300 * valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2301 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2302 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2303 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2304 * A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2305 * unlimited.
2306 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2307 * For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2308 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2309 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2310 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2311 * is used for non-data frames
2312 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2313 * specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2314 * link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2315 * the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2316 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2317 * i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2318 * would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2319 * STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2320 * @deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2321 * would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2322 * by the AP.
2323 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2324 */
2325 struct ieee80211_sta {
2326 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2327 u16 aid;
2328 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2329 bool wme;
2330 u8 uapsd_queues;
2331 u8 max_sp;
2332 struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2333 bool tdls;
2334 bool tdls_initiator;
2335 bool mfp;
2336 bool mlo;
2337 u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2338
2339 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2340
2341 bool support_p2p_ps;
2342
2343 struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2344
2345 u16 valid_links;
2346 struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2347 struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2348
2349 /* must be last */
2350 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2351 };
2352
2353 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2354 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2355 #else
lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta * pubsta)2356 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2357 {
2358 return true;
2359 }
2360 #endif
2361
2362 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id) \
2363 rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id], \
2364 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2365
2366 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id) \
2367 rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id], \
2368 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2369
2370 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id) \
2371 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++) \
2372 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \
2373 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \
2374 ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)))
2375
2376 /**
2377 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2378 *
2379 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2380 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2381 *
2382 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2383 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2384 */
2385 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2386 STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2387 };
2388
2389 /**
2390 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2391 *
2392 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2393 * it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2394 */
2395 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2396 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2397 };
2398
2399 /**
2400 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2401 *
2402 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2403 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2404 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2405 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2406 * @ac: the AC for this queue
2407 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2408 *
2409 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2410 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2411 */
2412 struct ieee80211_txq {
2413 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2414 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2415 u8 tid;
2416 u8 ac;
2417
2418 /* must be last */
2419 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2420 };
2421
2422 /**
2423 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2424 *
2425 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2426 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2427 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2428 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2429 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2430 *
2431 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2432 * The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2433 * controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2434 * should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2435 * will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2436 * algorithm.
2437 * Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2438 * callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2439 * the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2440 * @use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2441 * timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2442 * CCK frames.
2443 *
2444 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2445 * Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2446 * the FCS at the end.
2447 *
2448 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2449 * Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2450 * for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2451 * rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2452 * to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2453 * multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2454 * the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2455 *
2456 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2457 * Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2458 * expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2459 * If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2460 *
2461 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2462 * Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2463 * one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2464 * between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2465 *
2466 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2467 * Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2468 * Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2469 *
2470 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2471 * Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2472 *
2473 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2474 * Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2475 *
2476 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2477 * Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2478 * stack support for dynamic PS.
2479 *
2480 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2481 * Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2482 *
2483 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2484 * Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2485 *
2486 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2487 * Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2488 * the stack.
2489 *
2490 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2491 * The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2492 * periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2493 *
2494 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2495 * This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2496 * dtim_period).
2497 *
2498 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2499 * per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2500 * the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2501 * to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2502 * possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2503 * only in that case.
2504 *
2505 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2506 * autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2507 * this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2508 * stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2509 * Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2510 * the PS mode of connected stations.
2511 *
2512 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2513 * setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2514 * software.
2515 *
2516 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2517 * a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2518 * active interfaces.
2519 *
2520 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2521 * be created. It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2522 * desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2523 *
2524 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2525 * crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2526 * try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2527 * the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2528 * supported cipher suites.
2529 *
2530 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2531 * this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2532 * for frames.
2533 *
2534 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2535 * queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2536 * for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2537 * control for more details.
2538 *
2539 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2540 * selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2541 *
2542 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2543 * P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2544 * is supported.
2545 *
2546 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2547 * only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2548 *
2549 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2550 * and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2551 * using aggregation for such frames.)
2552 *
2553 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2554 * for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2555 * is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2556 * CSA frame.
2557 *
2558 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2559 * or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2560 *
2561 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2562 * in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2563 *
2564 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2565 * than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2566 *
2567 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2568 * within A-MPDU.
2569 *
2570 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2571 * for sent beacons.
2572 *
2573 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2574 * station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2575 * by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2576 * from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2577 *
2578 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2579 * reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2580 * order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2581 * timeout.
2582 *
2583 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2584 * which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2585 *
2586 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2587 * A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2588 * When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2589 * limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2590 * max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2591 *
2592 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2593 * skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2594 *
2595 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2596 * by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2597 * drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2598 * is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2599 *
2600 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2601 * The stack will not do fragmentation.
2602 * The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2603 *
2604 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2605 * TDLS links.
2606 *
2607 * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2608 * mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2609 * deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2610 * beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2611 * virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2612 * the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2613 * deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2614 *
2615 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2616 * support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2617 *
2618 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2619 * course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2620 *
2621 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2622 * extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2623 * the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2624 * but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2625 * See also the documentation for that flag.
2626 *
2627 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2628 * MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2629 * TXQs to start with.
2630 *
2631 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2632 * length in tx status information
2633 *
2634 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2635 *
2636 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2637 * only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2638 *
2639 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2640 * aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2641 * A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2642 *
2643 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2644 * offload
2645 *
2646 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2647 * offload
2648 *
2649 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2650 * decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2651 * If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2652 * usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2653 * the stack.
2654 *
2655 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2656 * collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2657 *
2658 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2659 * multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2660 *
2661 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2662 */
2663 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2664 IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2665 IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2666 IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2667 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2668 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2669 IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2670 IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2671 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2672 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2673 IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2674 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2675 IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2676 IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2677 IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2678 IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2679 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2680 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2681 IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2682 IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2683 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2684 IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2685 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2686 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2687 IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2688 IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2689 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2690 IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2691 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2692 IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2693 IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2694 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2695 IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2696 IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2697 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2698 IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2699 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2700 IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2701 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2702 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2703 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2704 IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2705 IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2706 IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2707 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2708 IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2709 IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2710 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2711 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2712 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2713 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2714 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2715 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2716 IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2717 IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2718
2719 /* keep last, obviously */
2720 NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2721 };
2722
2723 /**
2724 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2725 *
2726 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2727 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2728 *
2729 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2730 * 802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2731 * members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2732 * and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2733 * bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2734 *
2735 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2736 *
2737 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2738 * along with this structure.
2739 *
2740 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2741 *
2742 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2743 * for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2744 *
2745 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2746 * Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2747 *
2748 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2749 * only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2750 *
2751 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2752 * that HW supports
2753 *
2754 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2755 * data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2756 * queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2757 *
2758 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2759 * If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2760 * set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2761 *
2762 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2763 * within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2764 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2765 * within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2766 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2767 * within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2768 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2769 * within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2770 *
2771 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2772 * can handle.
2773 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2774 * the hw can report back.
2775 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2776 *
2777 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2778 * sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2779 * aggregation.
2780 * This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2781 * number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2782 * it shouldn't be set.
2783 *
2784 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2785 * aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2786 * advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2787 * the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2788 * with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2789 * For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2790 *
2791 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2792 * of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2793 *
2794 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2795 * (if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2796 *
2797 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2798 * reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2799 * include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2800 * adding _BW is supported today.
2801 *
2802 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2803 * the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2804 * Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2805 *
2806 * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags
2807 *
2808 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2809 * @units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2810 * field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2811 * device_timestamp.
2812 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2813 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2814 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2815 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2816 * radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2817 *
2818 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2819 * from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2820 * other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2821 *
2822 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2823 * for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2824 * enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2825 * Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2826 * that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2827 * neither enabled.
2828 *
2829 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2830 * deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2831 * Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2832 *
2833 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2834 * device.
2835 *
2836 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
2837 * them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
2838 * unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
2839 *
2840 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
2841 * refilling deficit of each TXQ.
2842 *
2843 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
2844 *
2845 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
2846 * The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
2847 * The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
2848 *
2849 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
2850 */
2851 struct ieee80211_hw {
2852 struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2853 struct wiphy *wiphy;
2854 const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2855 void *priv;
2856 unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2857 unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2858 unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2859 int vif_data_size;
2860 int sta_data_size;
2861 int chanctx_data_size;
2862 int txq_data_size;
2863 u16 queues;
2864 u16 max_listen_interval;
2865 s8 max_signal;
2866 u8 max_rates;
2867 u8 max_report_rates;
2868 u8 max_rate_tries;
2869 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2870 u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2871 u8 max_tx_fragments;
2872 u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2873 u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2874 u16 radiotap_vht_details;
2875 struct {
2876 int units_pos;
2877 s16 accuracy;
2878 } radiotap_timestamp;
2879 netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2880 u8 uapsd_queues;
2881 u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
2882 u8 max_nan_de_entries;
2883 u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
2884 u8 weight_multiplier;
2885 u32 max_mtu;
2886 const s8 *tx_power_levels;
2887 u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
2888 };
2889
_ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)2890 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2891 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2892 {
2893 return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2894 }
2895 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2896
_ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)2897 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2898 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2899 {
2900 return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2901 }
2902 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2903
2904 /**
2905 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
2906 *
2907 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
2908 * @req: cfg80211 request.
2909 */
2910 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
2911 struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
2912
2913 /* Keep last */
2914 struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
2915 };
2916
2917 /**
2918 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
2919 *
2920 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
2921 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
2922 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
2923 * @status: channel-switch response status
2924 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
2925 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2926 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2927 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
2928 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
2929 */
2930 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
2931 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2932 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
2933 u8 action_code;
2934 u32 status;
2935 u32 timestamp;
2936 u16 switch_time;
2937 u16 switch_timeout;
2938 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
2939 u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
2940 };
2941
2942 /**
2943 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
2944 *
2945 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
2946 *
2947 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
2948 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
2949 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
2950 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
2951 * is already used internally by mac80211.
2952 *
2953 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
2954 */
2955 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
2956
2957 /**
2958 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
2959 *
2960 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
2961 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
2962 */
SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct device * dev)2963 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
2964 {
2965 set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
2966 }
2967
2968 /**
2969 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
2970 *
2971 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
2972 * @addr: the address to set
2973 */
SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const u8 * addr)2974 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
2975 {
2976 memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
2977 }
2978
2979 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)2980 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2981 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2982 {
2983 if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
2984 return NULL;
2985 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
2986 }
2987
2988 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)2989 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2990 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2991 {
2992 if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
2993 return NULL;
2994 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
2995 }
2996
2997 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c,int idx)2998 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2999 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3000 {
3001 if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3002 return NULL;
3003 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3004 }
3005
3006 /**
3007 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3008 * @hw: the hardware
3009 * @skb: the skb
3010 *
3011 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3012 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3013 */
3014 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3015
3016 /**
3017 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3018 *
3019 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3020 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3021 *
3022 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3023 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3024 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3025 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3026 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3027 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3028 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3029 *
3030 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3031 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3032 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3033 *
3034 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3035 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3036 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3037 * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range.
3038 *
3039 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3040 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3041 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3042 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3043 *
3044 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3045 *
3046 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3047 * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any
3048 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3049 * based on the receive flags.
3050 *
3051 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3052 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3053 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3054 * keys.
3055 *
3056 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3057 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3058 * handler.
3059 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3060 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3061 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3062 * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3063 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3064 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3065 *
3066 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3067 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3068 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3069 *
3070 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3071 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3072 * requirements:
3073 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3074 once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3075 2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3076 at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3077 3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3078 encrypted with the new key when also needing
3079 @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3080 4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3081 Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3082 */
3083
3084 /**
3085 * DOC: Powersave support
3086 *
3087 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3088 *
3089 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself,
3090 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3091 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3092 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3093 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3094 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3095 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3096 * it finds traffic directed to it.
3097 *
3098 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3099 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3100 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3101 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3102 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3103 *
3104 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3105 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3106 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3107 *
3108 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3109 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3110 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3111 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3112 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3113 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3114 * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3115 *
3116 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3117 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3118 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3119 * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when
3120 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3121 * periods.
3122 *
3123 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3124 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3125 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3126 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3127 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3128 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3129 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3130 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3131 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3132 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3133 *
3134 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3135 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3136 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3137 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3138 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3139 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3140 *
3141 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3142 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3143 */
3144
3145 /**
3146 * DOC: Beacon filter support
3147 *
3148 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3149 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3150 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3151 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3152 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3153 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3154 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3155 *
3156 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3157 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3158 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3159 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3160 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3161 *
3162 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3163 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3164 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3165 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3166 *
3167 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3168 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3169 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3170 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3171 *
3172 * - a list of information element IDs
3173 * - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3174 *
3175 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3176 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3177 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3178 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3179 * vendor information elements.
3180 *
3181 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3182 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3183 *
3184 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing
3185 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3186 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3187 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3188 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3189 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3190 *
3191 *
3192 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3193 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3194 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3195 * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when
3196 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3197 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3198 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3199 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3200 *
3201 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3202 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3203 * signal strength threshold checking.
3204 */
3205
3206 /**
3207 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3208 *
3209 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3210 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3211 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3212 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3213 *
3214 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3215 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3216 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3217 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3218 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3219 * hardware flags.
3220 *
3221 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3222 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3223 * turned off otherwise.
3224 *
3225 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3226 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3227 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3228 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3229 */
3230
3231 /**
3232 * DOC: Frame filtering
3233 *
3234 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3235 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3236 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3237 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3238 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3239 *
3240 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3241 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3242 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3243 *
3244 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3245 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3246 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3247 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3248 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3249 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3250 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3251 *
3252 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3253 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3254 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3255 * or dropped.
3256 *
3257 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3258 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3259 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3260 * the flag, but not clear it.
3261 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3262 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3263 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3264 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3265 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3266 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3267 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3268 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3269 */
3270
3271 /**
3272 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3273 *
3274 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3275 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3276 * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3277 *
3278 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3279 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3280 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3281 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3282 * the driver code.
3283 *
3284 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3285 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3286 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3287 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3288 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3289 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3290 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3291 *
3292 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3293 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3294 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3295 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3296 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3297 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3298 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3299 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3300 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3301 * @sta_notify callback.
3302 *
3303 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3304 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3305 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3306 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3307 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3308 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3309 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3310 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3311 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3312 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3313 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3314 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3315 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3316 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3317 *
3318 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3319 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3320 *
3321 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3322 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3323 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3324 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3325 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3326 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3327 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3328 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3329 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3330 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3331 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3332 *
3333 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3334 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3335 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3336 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3337 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3338 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3339 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3340 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3341 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3342 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames,
3343 * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3344 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3345 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3346 * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3347 *
3348 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3349 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3350 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3351 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3352 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3353 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3354 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3355 *
3356 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3357 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3358 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3359 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3360 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3361 *
3362 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3363 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3364 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3365 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3366 */
3367
3368 /**
3369 * DOC: HW queue control
3370 *
3371 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3372 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3373 * was problematic for a few reasons:
3374 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3375 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3376 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3377 *
3378 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3379 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3380 * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3381 *
3382 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3383 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3384 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3385 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3386 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3387 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3388 * the hardware queue.
3389 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3390 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3391 *
3392 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual
3393 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3394 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3395 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3396 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3397 *
3398 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3399 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3400 * after-DTIM queue for AP: 8
3401 * off-channel queue: 9
3402 *
3403 * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3404 * hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3405 *
3406 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3407 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3408 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3409 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3410 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3411 * vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3412 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3413 *
3414 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3415 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3416 *
3417 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3418 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3419 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3420 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3421 */
3422
3423 /**
3424 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3425 *
3426 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3427 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3428 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3429 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3430 *
3431 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3432 * by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3433 * multicast address.
3434 *
3435 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3436 * %RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3437 *
3438 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3439 * the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3440 *
3441 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3442 * to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3443 * by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3444 * mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3445 * honour this flag if possible.
3446 *
3447 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3448 * station
3449 *
3450 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3451 *
3452 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3453 *
3454 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3455 *
3456 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3457 */
3458 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3459 FIF_ALLMULTI = 1<<1,
3460 FIF_FCSFAIL = 1<<2,
3461 FIF_PLCPFAIL = 1<<3,
3462 FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC = 1<<4,
3463 FIF_CONTROL = 1<<5,
3464 FIF_OTHER_BSS = 1<<6,
3465 FIF_PSPOLL = 1<<7,
3466 FIF_PROBE_REQ = 1<<8,
3467 FIF_MCAST_ACTION = 1<<9,
3468 };
3469
3470 /**
3471 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3472 *
3473 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3474 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3475 *
3476 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3477 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3478 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3479 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3480 *
3481 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3482 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3483 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3484 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3485 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3486 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3487 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3488 * status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3489 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3490 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3491 * queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3492 * driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3493 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3494 * called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3495 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3496 * session is gone and removes the station.
3497 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3498 * but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3499 * now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3500 * should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3501 */
3502 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3503 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3504 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3505 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3506 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3507 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3508 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3509 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3510 };
3511
3512 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3513 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3514
3515 /**
3516 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3517 *
3518 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3519 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3520 * @tid: tid of the BA session
3521 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3522 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3523 * actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3524 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3525 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3526 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3527 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3528 * valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3529 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3530 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3531 */
3532 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3533 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3534 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3535 u16 tid;
3536 u16 ssn;
3537 u16 buf_size;
3538 bool amsdu;
3539 u16 timeout;
3540 };
3541
3542 /**
3543 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3544 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3545 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3546 * frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3547 */
3548 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3549 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3550 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3551 };
3552
3553 /**
3554 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3555 *
3556 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3557 * to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3558 * information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3559 * flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3560 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3561 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3562 * changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3563 * the peer.
3564 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3565 * by the peer
3566 */
3567 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3568 IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0),
3569 IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED = BIT(1),
3570 IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED = BIT(2),
3571 IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED = BIT(3),
3572 };
3573
3574 /**
3575 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3576 *
3577 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3578 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3579 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3580 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3581 * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3582 *
3583 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3584 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3585 * for sending management frames offchannel.
3586 */
3587 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3588 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3589 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3590 };
3591
3592 /**
3593 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3594 *
3595 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3596 * reconfiguration type was completed.
3597 *
3598 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3599 * (also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3600 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3601 * of wowlan configuration)
3602 */
3603 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3604 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3605 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3606 };
3607
3608 /**
3609 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3610 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3611 * only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3612 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3613 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3614 * used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3615 * valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3616 */
3617 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3618 u16 duration;
3619 u16 subtype;
3620 u8 success:1;
3621 };
3622
3623 /**
3624 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3625 *
3626 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3627 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3628 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3629 *
3630 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3631 * skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3632 * The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3633 * configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3634 * preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3635 * Must be atomic.
3636 *
3637 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3638 * is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3639 * frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3640 * Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3641 * or zero.
3642 * When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3643 * to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3644 * is added.
3645 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3646 *
3647 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3648 * is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3649 * it must turn off frame reception.)
3650 * May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3651 * an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3652 * you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3653 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3654 *
3655 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3656 * stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3657 * ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3658 * configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3659 * reconfigured at resume time.
3660 * The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3661 * wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3662 * supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3663 * must return 1 from this function.
3664 *
3665 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3666 * now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3667 * functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3668 * to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3669 * will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3670 *
3671 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3672 * modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3673 * supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3674 * in suspend().
3675 *
3676 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3677 * enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3678 * and @stop must be implemented.
3679 * The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3680 * the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3681 * interface is given in the conf parameter.
3682 * The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3683 * negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3684 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3685 *
3686 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3687 * is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3688 * switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3689 * Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3690 * found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3691 *
3692 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3693 * The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3694 * and no monitor interfaces are present.
3695 * When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3696 * must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3697 * the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3698 * MAC address of the device going away.
3699 * Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3700 *
3701 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3702 * function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3703 * This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3704 * if it does. The callback can sleep.
3705 *
3706 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3707 * parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3708 * level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3709 * This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3710 * for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3711 * of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3712 * can sleep.
3713 * Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3714 * are not implemented.
3715 *
3716 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3717 * (MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3718 * lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3719 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3720 * The callback can sleep.
3721 *
3722 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3723 * parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3724 * individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3725 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3726 * parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3727 * non-MLO connections.
3728 * The callback can sleep.
3729 *
3730 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3731 * This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3732 * to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3733 *
3734 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3735 * See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3736 * This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3737 *
3738 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3739 * This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3740 * should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3741 * of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3742 * which flags are changed.
3743 * This callback can sleep.
3744 *
3745 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3746 * must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3747 *
3748 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3749 * This callback is only called between add_interface and
3750 * remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3751 * is enabled.
3752 * Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3753 * The callback can sleep.
3754 *
3755 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3756 * This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3757 * which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3758 * The callback must be atomic.
3759 *
3760 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3761 * host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3762 * necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3763 * After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3764 * userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3765 *
3766 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3767 * WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3768 * offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3769 *
3770 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3771 * the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3772 * configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3773 * registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3774 * that power save is disabled.
3775 * The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3776 * entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3777 * at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3778 * (extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3779 * When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3780 * note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3781 * any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3782 * This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3783 * this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3784 * software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3785 * capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3786 * advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3787 * The callback can sleep.
3788 *
3789 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3790 * The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3791 * but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3792 * ieee80211_scan_completed().
3793 * This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3794 * scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3795 * The callback can sleep.
3796 *
3797 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3798 * specific intervals. The driver must call the
3799 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3800 * This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3801 *
3802 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3803 * In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3804 *
3805 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3806 * is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3807 * The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3808 * the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3809 * can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3810 *
3811 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3812 * software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3813 * this notification.
3814 * The callback can sleep.
3815 *
3816 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3817 * Returns zero if statistics are available.
3818 * The callback can sleep.
3819 *
3820 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3821 * IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3822 * IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3823 * The callback must be atomic.
3824 *
3825 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3826 * if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3827 * stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3828 * should be set as well.
3829 * The callback can sleep.
3830 *
3831 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3832 * The callback can sleep.
3833 *
3834 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3835 * AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3836 *
3837 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3838 * station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3839 * returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3840 * no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3841 * the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3842 * This callback can sleep.
3843 *
3844 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3845 * when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3846 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3847 * callback can sleep.
3848 *
3849 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3850 * when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
3851 * should be within a CPTCFG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3852 * callback can sleep.
3853 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
3854 * station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3855 *
3856 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3857 * associated station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3858 * in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3859 * %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3860 *
3861 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
3862 * power for the station.
3863 * This callback can sleep.
3864 *
3865 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
3866 * station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
3867 * This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
3868 * It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
3869 * up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
3870 * isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
3871 * period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
3872 * See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3873 * The callback can sleep.
3874 *
3875 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
3876 * synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
3877 * pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
3878 * the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
3879 * in @sta_state.
3880 * The callback can sleep.
3881 *
3882 * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
3883 * used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
3884 * from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
3885 * in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
3886 * uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
3887 * otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
3888 * Must be atomic.
3889 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
3890 * is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
3891 * the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
3892 *
3893 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
3894 * filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
3895 * let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
3896 * the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
3897 * all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
3898 * Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
3899 * The callback can sleep.
3900 *
3901 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
3902 * bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
3903 * Returns a negative error code on failure.
3904 * The callback can sleep.
3905 *
3906 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
3907 * this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
3908 * required function.
3909 * The callback can sleep.
3910 *
3911 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
3912 * Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
3913 * required function.
3914 * The callback can sleep.
3915 *
3916 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
3917 * firmware/hardware. Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
3918 * calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
3919 * as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
3920 * The callback can sleep.
3921 *
3922 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
3923 * with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
3924 * function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
3925 * TSF synchronization.
3926 * The callback can sleep.
3927 *
3928 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
3929 * This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
3930 * used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
3931 * Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
3932 * The callback can sleep.
3933 *
3934 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
3935 *
3936 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
3937 * need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
3938 * and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
3939 * The callback can sleep.
3940 *
3941 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
3942 * in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
3943 * accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
3944 * estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
3945 * coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
3946 *
3947 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
3948 * be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
3949 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
3950 *
3951 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
3952 * that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
3953 * of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
3954 * use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
3955 * If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
3956 * Note that vif can be NULL.
3957 * The callback can sleep.
3958 *
3959 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
3960 * switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
3961 * callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
3962 * completion of the channel switch.
3963 *
3964 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3965 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3966 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3967 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3968 *
3969 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3970 *
3971 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
3972 * call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
3973 * that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
3974 * offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
3975 * normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
3976 * duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
3977 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
3978 * Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
3979 * must be accepted in this case.
3980 * This callback may sleep.
3981 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
3982 * aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
3983 *
3984 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
3985 *
3986 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
3987 *
3988 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
3989 * queues before entering power save.
3990 *
3991 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
3992 * when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
3993 * The callback can sleep.
3994 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
3995 * &enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
3996 * The callback must be atomic.
3997 *
3998 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
3999 * parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4000 * sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4001 * to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4002 * Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4003 * if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4004 * the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4005 * the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4006 * more-data bit must always be set.
4007 * The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4008 * from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4009 * In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4010 * @num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4011 * this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4012 * on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4013 * period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4014 * responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4015 * In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4016 * bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4017 * at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4018 * setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4019 * service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4020 * on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4021 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4022 * This callback must be atomic.
4023 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4024 * to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4025 * via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4026 * released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4027 * and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4028 * frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4029 * them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4030 * on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4031 * bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4032 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4033 * The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4034 * frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4035 * This callback must be atomic.
4036 *
4037 * @get_et_sset_count: Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4038 *
4039 * @get_et_stats: Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4040 *
4041 * @get_et_strings: Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4042 * and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4043 *
4044 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4045 * before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4046 * bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4047 * yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4048 * transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4049 * powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4050 * management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
4051 * driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
4052 * and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
4053 * For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
4054 * would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
4055 * frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
4056 * The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4057 * mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4058 * Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4059 * data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4060 * driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4061 * The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4062 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4063 * transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4064 * is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4065 *
4066 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4067 * a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4068 * channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4069 * setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4070 * mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4071 * discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4072 * 2 * (DTIM period).
4073 * The callback is optional and can sleep.
4074 *
4075 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4076 * This callback may sleep.
4077 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4078 * This callback may sleep.
4079 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4080 * may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4081 * channel context with different settings
4082 * This callback may sleep.
4083 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4084 * to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4085 * This callback may sleep.
4086 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4087 * unbound from vif.
4088 * This callback may sleep.
4089 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4090 * another, as specified in the list of
4091 * @ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4092 * to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4093 * This callback may sleep.
4094 *
4095 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4096 * information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4097 * context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4098 * software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4099 * just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4100 * disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4101 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4102 *
4103 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4104 * during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4105 * This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4106 * indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4107 * This callback may sleep.
4108 *
4109 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4110 * Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4111 * This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4112 *
4113 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4114 * Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4115 * function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4116 * decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4117 * ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4118 * get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4119 * 1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4120 * transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4121 * If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4122 * since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4123 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4124 * before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4125 * gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4126 * the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4127 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4128 * after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4129 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4130 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4131 * when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the
4132 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4133 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4134 * when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4135 * CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4136 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4137 * information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4138 * channel context is bound before this is called.
4139 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4140 *
4141 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4142 * specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4143 * if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4144 *
4145 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4146 * and hardware limits.
4147 *
4148 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4149 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4150 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4151 * driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4152 * the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4153 * The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4154 * optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4155 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4156 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4157 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4158 * response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4159 * parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4160 * an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4161 * response template is provided, together with the location of the
4162 * switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4163 * the function call.
4164 *
4165 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4166 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4167 * synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4168 * pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4169 * currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4170 *
4171 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4172 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4173 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4174 * contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4175 * are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4176 * The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4177 * some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4178 * changed parameters.
4179 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4180 * cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4181 * this call.
4182 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4183 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4184 * NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4185 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4186 * aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4187 * between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4188 * skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4189 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4190 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4191 *
4192 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4193 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4194 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4195 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4196 * This callback may sleep.
4197 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4198 * This callback may sleep.
4199 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4200 * 4-address mode
4201 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4202 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4203 * to use rx decapsulation offload
4204 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4205 * This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4206 * are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4207 * The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4208 * twt structure.
4209 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4210 * from the peer.
4211 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4212 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4213 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4214 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4215 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4216 * radar channel.
4217 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4218 * disable background CAC/radar detection.
4219 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4220 * resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4221 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4222 * removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4223 * but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4224 * new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4225 * The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4226 * that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4227 * This callback can sleep.
4228 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4229 * @change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4230 * Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4231 * i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4232 * In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4233 */
4234 struct ieee80211_ops {
4235 void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4236 struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4237 struct sk_buff *skb);
4238 int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4239 void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4240 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4241 int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4242 int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4243 void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4244 #endif
4245 int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4246 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4247 int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4248 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4249 enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4250 void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4251 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4252 int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4253 void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4254 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4255 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4256 u64 changed);
4257 void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4258 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4259 u64 changed);
4260 void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4261 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4262 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4263 u64 changed);
4264
4265 int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4266 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4267 void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4268 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4269
4270 u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4271 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4272 void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4273 unsigned int changed_flags,
4274 unsigned int *total_flags,
4275 u64 multicast);
4276 void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4277 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4278 unsigned int filter_flags,
4279 unsigned int changed_flags);
4280 int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4281 bool set);
4282 int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4283 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4284 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4285 void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4286 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4287 struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4288 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4289 u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4290 void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4291 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4292 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4293 void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4294 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4295 int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4296 struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4297 void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4298 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4299 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4300 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4301 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4302 struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4303 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4304 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4305 void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4306 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4307 const u8 *mac_addr);
4308 void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4309 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4310 int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4311 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4312 void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4313 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4314 struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4315 int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4316 int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4317 int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4318 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4319 int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4320 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4321 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4322 void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4323 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4324 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4325 struct dentry *dir);
4326 void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4327 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4328 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4329 struct dentry *dir);
4330 #endif
4331 void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4332 enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4333 int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4334 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4335 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4336 int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4337 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4338 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4339 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4340 void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4341 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4342 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4343 void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4344 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4345 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4346 u32 changed);
4347 void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4348 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4349 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4350 void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4351 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4352 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4353 struct station_info *sinfo);
4354 int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4355 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4356 unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4357 const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4358 u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4359 void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4360 u64 tsf);
4361 void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4362 s64 offset);
4363 void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4364 int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4365
4366 /**
4367 * @ampdu_action:
4368 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4369 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4370 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4371 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4372 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4373 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4374 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4375 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4376 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4377 *
4378 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4379 * - ``RX: 2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4380 * - ``TX: 8..1...``
4381 *
4382 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4383 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4384 *
4385 * - ``TX: 1 or``
4386 * - ``TX: 18 or``
4387 * - ``TX: 81``
4388 *
4389 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4390 *
4391 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4392 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4393 * if the session can start immediately.
4394 *
4395 * The callback can sleep.
4396 */
4397 int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4398 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4399 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4400 int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4401 struct survey_info *survey);
4402 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4403 void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4404 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4405 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4406 void *data, int len);
4407 int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4408 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4409 void *data, int len);
4410 #endif
4411 void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4412 u32 queues, bool drop);
4413 void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4414 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4415 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4416 int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4417 int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4418
4419 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4420 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4421 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4422 int duration,
4423 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4424 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4425 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4426 int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4427 void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4428 u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4429 bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4430 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4431 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4432 void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4433 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4434 const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4435
4436 void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4437 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4438 u16 tids, int num_frames,
4439 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4440 bool more_data);
4441 void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4442 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4443 u16 tids, int num_frames,
4444 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4445 bool more_data);
4446
4447 int (*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4448 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4449 void (*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4450 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4451 struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4452 void (*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4453 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4454 u32 sset, u8 *data);
4455
4456 void (*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4457 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4458 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4459 void (*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4460 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4461 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4462
4463 void (*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4464 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4465
4466 int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4467 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4468 void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4469 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4470 void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4471 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4472 u32 changed);
4473 int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4474 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4475 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4476 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4477 void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4478 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4479 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4480 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4481 int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4482 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4483 int n_vifs,
4484 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4485
4486 void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4487 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4488
4489 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4490 void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4491 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4492 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4493 #endif
4494 void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4495 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4496 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4497 int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4498 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4499 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4500
4501 int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4502 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4503 void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4504 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4505 void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4506 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4507 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4508
4509 int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4510 void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4511 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4512 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4513 int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4514 int *dbm);
4515
4516 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4517 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4518 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4519 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4520 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4521 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4522 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4523 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4524 void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4525 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4526 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4527
4528 void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4529 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4530 void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4531
4532 int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4533 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4534 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4535 int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4536 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4537 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4538 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4539 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4540 int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4541 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4542 const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4543 void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4544 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4545 u8 instance_id);
4546 bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4547 struct sk_buff *head,
4548 struct sk_buff *skb);
4549 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4550 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4551 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4552 int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4553 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4554 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4555 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4556 int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4557 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4558 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4559 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4560 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4561 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4562 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4563 void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4564 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4565 void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4566 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4567 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4568 const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4569 void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4570 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4571 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4572 void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4573 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4574 struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4575 void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4576 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4577 int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4578 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4579 int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4580 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4581 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4582 struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4583 struct net_device_path *path);
4584 int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4585 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4586 u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4587 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4588 int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4589 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4590 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4591 u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4592 };
4593
4594 /**
4595 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4596 *
4597 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4598 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4599 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4600 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4601 * @priv_data_len.
4602 *
4603 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4604 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4605 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4606 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4607 *
4608 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4609 */
4610 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4611 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4612 const char *requested_name);
4613
4614 /**
4615 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4616 *
4617 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4618 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4619 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4620 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4621 * @priv_data_len.
4622 *
4623 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4624 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4625 *
4626 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4627 */
4628 static inline
ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,const struct ieee80211_ops * ops)4629 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4630 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4631 {
4632 return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4633 }
4634
4635 /**
4636 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4637 *
4638 * You must call this function before any other functions in
4639 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4640 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4641 *
4642 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4643 *
4644 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4645 */
4646 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4647
4648 /**
4649 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4650 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4651 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4652 * (full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4653 */
4654 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4655 int throughput;
4656 int blink_time;
4657 };
4658
4659 /**
4660 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4661 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4662 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4663 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4664 * interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4665 */
4666 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4667 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO = BIT(0),
4668 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK = BIT(1),
4669 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED = BIT(2),
4670 };
4671
4672 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4673 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4674 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4675 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4676 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4677 const char *
4678 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4679 unsigned int flags,
4680 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4681 unsigned int blink_table_len);
4682 #endif
4683 /**
4684 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4685 *
4686 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4687 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4688 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4689 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4690 *
4691 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4692 *
4693 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4694 */
ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4695 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4696 {
4697 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4698 return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4699 #else
4700 return NULL;
4701 #endif
4702 }
4703
4704 /**
4705 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4706 *
4707 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4708 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4709 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4710 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4711 *
4712 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4713 *
4714 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4715 */
ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4716 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4717 {
4718 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4719 return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4720 #else
4721 return NULL;
4722 #endif
4723 }
4724
4725 /**
4726 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4727 *
4728 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4729 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4730 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4731 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4732 *
4733 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4734 *
4735 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4736 */
ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4737 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4738 {
4739 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4740 return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4741 #else
4742 return NULL;
4743 #endif
4744 }
4745
4746 /**
4747 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4748 *
4749 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4750 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4751 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4752 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4753 *
4754 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4755 *
4756 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4757 */
ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4758 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4759 {
4760 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4761 return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
4762 #else
4763 return NULL;
4764 #endif
4765 }
4766
4767 /**
4768 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
4769 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
4770 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
4771 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
4772 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
4773 *
4774 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
4775 * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
4776 *
4777 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
4778 */
4779 static inline const char *
ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,unsigned int flags,const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink * blink_table,unsigned int blink_table_len)4780 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
4781 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4782 unsigned int blink_table_len)
4783 {
4784 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4785 return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
4786 blink_table_len);
4787 #else
4788 return NULL;
4789 #endif
4790 }
4791
4792 /**
4793 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
4794 *
4795 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
4796 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
4797 *
4798 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
4799 */
4800 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4801
4802 /**
4803 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
4804 *
4805 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
4806 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
4807 * before calling this function.
4808 *
4809 * @hw: the hardware to free
4810 */
4811 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4812
4813 /**
4814 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4815 *
4816 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
4817 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
4818 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
4819 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
4820 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
4821 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
4822 *
4823 * @hw: the hardware to restart
4824 */
4825 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4826
4827 /**
4828 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
4829 *
4830 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4831 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4832 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4833 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4834 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4835 *
4836 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4837 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4838 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4839 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4840 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4841 *
4842 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
4843 *
4844 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4845 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4846 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4847 * @list: the destination list
4848 */
4849 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4850 struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
4851
4852 /**
4853 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
4854 *
4855 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4856 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4857 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4858 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4859 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4860 *
4861 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4862 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4863 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4864 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4865 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4866 *
4867 * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
4868 *
4869 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4870 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4871 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4872 * @napi: the NAPI context
4873 */
4874 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4875 struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
4876
4877 /**
4878 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
4879 *
4880 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4881 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4882 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4883 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4884 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4885 *
4886 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4887 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4888 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4889 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4890 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4891 *
4892 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
4893 *
4894 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4895 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4896 */
ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)4897 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
4898 {
4899 ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
4900 }
4901
4902 /**
4903 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
4904 *
4905 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
4906 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4907 *
4908 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
4909 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
4910 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4911 *
4912 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4913 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4914 */
4915 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
4916
4917 /**
4918 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
4919 *
4920 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
4921 * (internally disables bottom halves).
4922 *
4923 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
4924 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4925 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4926 *
4927 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4928 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4929 */
ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)4930 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4931 struct sk_buff *skb)
4932 {
4933 local_bh_disable();
4934 ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
4935 local_bh_enable();
4936 }
4937
4938 /**
4939 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
4940 *
4941 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
4942 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
4943 * entering/leaving PS mode.
4944 *
4945 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
4946 *
4947 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
4948 * each other.
4949 *
4950 * @sta: currently connected sta
4951 * @start: start or stop PS
4952 *
4953 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
4954 */
4955 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
4956
4957 /**
4958 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
4959 * (in process context)
4960 *
4961 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
4962 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
4963 * applies.
4964 *
4965 * @sta: currently connected sta
4966 * @start: start or stop PS
4967 *
4968 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
4969 */
ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,bool start)4970 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4971 bool start)
4972 {
4973 int ret;
4974
4975 local_bh_disable();
4976 ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
4977 local_bh_enable();
4978
4979 return ret;
4980 }
4981
4982 /**
4983 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
4984 * @sta: currently connected station
4985 *
4986 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4987 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
4988 * connected station was received.
4989 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4990 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
4991 * be serialized.
4992 */
4993 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4994
4995 /**
4996 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
4997 * @sta: currently connected station
4998 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
4999 *
5000 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5001 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5002 * from a connected station was received.
5003 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5004 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5005 * serialized.
5006 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5007 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5008 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5009 * checks.
5010 */
5011 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5012
5013 /*
5014 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5015 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5016 */
5017 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM ALIGN(14, 4)
5018
5019 /**
5020 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5021 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5022 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5023 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5024 *
5025 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5026 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5027 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5028 *
5029 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5030 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5031 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5032 * call! Beware of the locking!)
5033 *
5034 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5035 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5036 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5037 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5038 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5039 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5040 *
5041 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5042 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5043 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5044 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5045 * use this API.
5046 */
5047 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5048 u8 tid, bool buffered);
5049
5050 /**
5051 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5052 *
5053 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5054 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5055 * rate selection table for the station entry.
5056 *
5057 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5058 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5059 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5060 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5061 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5062 */
5063 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5064 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5065 struct sk_buff *skb,
5066 struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5067 int max_rates);
5068
5069 /**
5070 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
5071 *
5072 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
5073 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
5074 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
5075 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
5076 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
5077 * slow stations to starve).
5078 *
5079 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
5080 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
5081 */
5082 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5083 u32 thr);
5084
5085 /**
5086 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5087 *
5088 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5089 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5090 * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5091 *
5092 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5093 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5094 * @info: tx status information
5095 */
5096 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5097 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5098 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5099
5100 /**
5101 * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback
5102 *
5103 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5104 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5105 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5106 *
5107 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5108 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5109 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5110 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5111 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5112 *
5113 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5114 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5115 */
5116 void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5117 struct sk_buff *skb);
5118
5119 /**
5120 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5121 *
5122 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5123 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5124 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5125 *
5126 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5127 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5128 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5129 *
5130 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5131 * @status: tx status information
5132 */
5133 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5134 struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5135
5136 /**
5137 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5138 *
5139 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5140 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5141 * specific skbs.
5142 *
5143 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5144 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5145 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5146 *
5147 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5148 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5149 * (NULL for multicast packets)
5150 * @info: tx status information
5151 */
ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_sta * sta,struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)5152 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5153 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5154 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5155 {
5156 struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5157 .sta = sta,
5158 .info = info,
5159 };
5160
5161 ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5162 }
5163
5164 /**
5165 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5166 *
5167 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context.
5168 *
5169 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5170 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5171 * for a single hardware.
5172 *
5173 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5174 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5175 */
ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5176 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5177 struct sk_buff *skb)
5178 {
5179 local_bh_disable();
5180 ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb);
5181 local_bh_enable();
5182 }
5183
5184 /**
5185 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5186 *
5187 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context
5188 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5189 *
5190 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5191 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5192 *
5193 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5194 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5195 */
5196 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5197 struct sk_buff *skb);
5198
5199 /**
5200 * ieee80211_tx_status_8023 - transmit status callback for 802.3 frame format
5201 *
5202 * Call this function for all transmitted data frames after their transmit
5203 * completion. This callback should only be called for data frames which
5204 * are using driver's (or hardware's) offload capability of encap/decap
5205 * 802.11 frames.
5206 *
5207 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5208 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other and all
5209 * calls in the same tx status family.
5210 *
5211 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5212 * @vif: the interface for which the frame was transmitted
5213 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5214 */
5215 void ieee80211_tx_status_8023(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5216 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5217 struct sk_buff *skb);
5218
5219 /**
5220 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5221 *
5222 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5223 * connected STA.
5224 *
5225 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5226 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5227 */
5228 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5229
5230 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5231
5232 /**
5233 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5234 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5235 * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5236 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5237 * to countdown counters. This array can contain zero values which
5238 * should be ignored.
5239 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5240 */
5241 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5242 u16 tim_offset;
5243 u16 tim_length;
5244
5245 u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5246 u16 mbssid_off;
5247 };
5248
5249 /**
5250 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5251 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5252 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5253 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5254 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5255 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5256 *
5257 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5258 * obtain the beacon template.
5259 *
5260 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5261 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5262 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5263 * applicable, the CSA count.
5264 *
5265 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5266 *
5267 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5268 */
5269 struct sk_buff *
5270 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5271 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5272 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5273 unsigned int link_id);
5274
5275 /**
5276 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5277 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5278 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5279 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5280 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5281 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5282 * (including the ID and length bytes!).
5283 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5284 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5285 *
5286 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5287 * obtain the beacon frame.
5288 *
5289 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5290 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5291 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5292 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5293 *
5294 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5295 *
5296 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5297 */
5298 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5299 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5300 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5301 unsigned int link_id);
5302
5303 /**
5304 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5305 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5306 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5307 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5308 *
5309 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5310 *
5311 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5312 */
ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)5313 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5314 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5315 unsigned int link_id)
5316 {
5317 return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5318 }
5319
5320 /**
5321 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5322 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5323 *
5324 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5325 * This function is called implicitly when
5326 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5327 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5328 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5329 *
5330 * Return: new countdown value
5331 */
5332 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5333
5334 /**
5335 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5336 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5337 * @counter: the new value for the counter
5338 *
5339 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5340 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5341 *
5342 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5343 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5344 */
5345 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5346
5347 /**
5348 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5349 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5350 *
5351 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5352 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5353 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5354 */
5355 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5356
5357 /**
5358 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5359 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5360 *
5361 * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero.
5362 */
5363 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5364
5365 /**
5366 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5367 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5368 *
5369 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5370 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5371 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5372 */
5373 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5374
5375 /**
5376 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5377 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5378 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5379 *
5380 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5381 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5382 *
5383 * Can only be called in AP mode.
5384 *
5385 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5386 */
5387 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5388 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5389
5390 /**
5391 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5392 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5393 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5394 *
5395 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5396 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5397 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5398 *
5399 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5400 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5401 *
5402 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5403 */
5404 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5405 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5406
5407 /**
5408 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5409 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5410 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5411 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5412 * for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5413 * MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5414 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5415 * if at all possible
5416 *
5417 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5418 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5419 * BSSID and address is used.
5420 *
5421 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5422 * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5423 *
5424 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5425 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5426 *
5427 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5428 */
5429 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5430 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5431 int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5432
5433 /**
5434 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5435 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5436 * @src_addr: source MAC address
5437 * @ssid: SSID buffer
5438 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5439 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5440 *
5441 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5442 * hardware.
5443 *
5444 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5445 */
5446 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5447 const u8 *src_addr,
5448 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5449 size_t tailroom);
5450
5451 /**
5452 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5453 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5454 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5455 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5456 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5457 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5458 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5459 *
5460 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5461 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5462 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5463 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5464 */
5465 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5466 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5467 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5468 struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5469
5470 /**
5471 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5472 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5473 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5474 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5475 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5476 *
5477 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5478 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5479 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5480 *
5481 * Return: The duration.
5482 */
5483 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5484 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5485 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5486
5487 /**
5488 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5489 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5490 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5491 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5492 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5493 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5494 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5495 *
5496 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5497 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5498 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5499 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5500 */
5501 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5502 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5503 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5504 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5505 struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5506
5507 /**
5508 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5509 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5510 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5511 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5512 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5513 *
5514 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5515 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5516 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5517 *
5518 * Return: The duration.
5519 */
5520 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5521 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5522 size_t frame_len,
5523 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5524
5525 /**
5526 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5527 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5528 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5529 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5530 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5531 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5532 *
5533 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5534 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5535 *
5536 * Return: The duration.
5537 */
5538 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5539 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5540 enum nl80211_band band,
5541 size_t frame_len,
5542 struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5543
5544 /**
5545 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5546 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5547 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5548 *
5549 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5550 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5551 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5552 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5553 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5554 *
5555 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5556 * frames are available.
5557 *
5558 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5559 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5560 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5561 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5562 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5563 * use common code for all beacons.
5564 */
5565 struct sk_buff *
5566 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5567
5568 /**
5569 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5570 *
5571 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5572 *
5573 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5574 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5575 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5576 */
5577 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5578 u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5579
5580 /**
5581 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5582 *
5583 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5584 * from the given packet.
5585 *
5586 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5587 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5588 * with this P1K
5589 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5590 */
ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf * keyconf,struct sk_buff * skb,u16 * p1k)5591 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5592 struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5593 {
5594 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5595 const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5596 u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5597
5598 ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5599 }
5600
5601 /**
5602 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5603 *
5604 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5605 * and transmitter address.
5606 *
5607 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5608 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5609 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5610 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5611 */
5612 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5613 const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5614
5615 /**
5616 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5617 *
5618 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5619 * in the packet.
5620 *
5621 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5622 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5623 * encrypted with this key
5624 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5625 */
5626 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5627 struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5628
5629 /**
5630 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5631 *
5632 * @pos: start of crypto header
5633 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5634 * @pn: PN to add
5635 *
5636 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5637 * the packet payload)
5638 *
5639 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5640 * point to the crypto header)
5641 */
5642 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5643
5644 /**
5645 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5646 *
5647 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5648 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5649 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5650 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5651 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5652 *
5653 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5654 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5655 * by the device and not by mac80211.
5656 *
5657 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5658 * can be done concurrently.
5659 */
5660 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5661 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5662
5663 /**
5664 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5665 *
5666 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5667 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5668 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5669 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5670 * @seq: new sequence data
5671 *
5672 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5673 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5674 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5675 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5676 *
5677 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5678 * can be done concurrently.
5679 */
5680 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5681 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5682
5683 /**
5684 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5685 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5686 *
5687 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5688 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5689 * instead assumed to have been removed already.
5690 *
5691 * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently)
5692 * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().)
5693 */
5694 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5695
5696 /**
5697 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5698 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5699 * @keyconf: new key data
5700 *
5701 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5702 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5703 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
5704 *
5705 * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
5706 * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
5707 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
5708 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
5709 *
5710 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
5711 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
5712 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
5713 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
5714 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
5715 * of the reconfiguration.
5716 *
5717 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
5718 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
5719 *
5720 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
5721 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
5722 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
5723 * the key that's being replaced.
5724 */
5725 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
5726 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5727 struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5728
5729 /**
5730 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
5731 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
5732 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
5733 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
5734 * @gfp: allocation flags
5735 */
5736 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
5737 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
5738
5739 /**
5740 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
5741 *
5742 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5743 * at the same time.
5744 *
5745 * @keyconf: the key in question
5746 */
5747 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5748
5749 /**
5750 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
5751 *
5752 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5753 * at the same time.
5754 *
5755 * @keyconf: the key in question
5756 */
5757 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5758
5759 /**
5760 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
5761 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5762 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5763 *
5764 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5765 */
5766 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5767
5768 /**
5769 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
5770 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5771 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5772 *
5773 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5774 */
5775 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5776
5777 /**
5778 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
5779 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5780 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5781 *
5782 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
5783 *
5784 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
5785 */
5786
5787 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5788
5789 /**
5790 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
5791 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5792 *
5793 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
5794 */
5795 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5796
5797 /**
5798 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
5799 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5800 *
5801 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
5802 */
5803 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5804
5805 /**
5806 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
5807 *
5808 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
5809 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
5810 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
5811 * any context, including hardirq context.
5812 *
5813 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
5814 * @info: information about the completed scan
5815 */
5816 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5817 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
5818
5819 /**
5820 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
5821 *
5822 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
5823 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
5824 *
5825 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5826 */
5827 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5828
5829 /**
5830 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
5831 *
5832 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
5833 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
5834 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
5835 * while associating, for instance.
5836 *
5837 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5838 */
5839 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5840
5841 /**
5842 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
5843 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
5844 * been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
5845 * reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
5846 * interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
5847 * haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5848 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
5849 * interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5850 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
5851 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
5852 * is not in the driver. This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
5853 * for instance.
5854 */
5855 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
5856 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL = 0,
5857 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL = BIT(0),
5858 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE = BIT(1),
5859 IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER = BIT(2),
5860 };
5861
5862 /**
5863 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
5864 *
5865 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5866 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
5867 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
5868 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5869 *
5870 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5871 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5872 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5873 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5874 */
5875 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5876 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5877 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5878 void *data);
5879
5880 /**
5881 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
5882 *
5883 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5884 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5885 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
5886 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
5887 * be used.
5888 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5889 *
5890 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5891 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5892 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5893 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5894 */
5895 static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u32 iter_flags,void (* iterator)(void * data,u8 * mac,struct ieee80211_vif * vif),void * data)5896 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5897 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5898 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5899 void *data)
5900 {
5901 ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
5902 iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
5903 iterator, data);
5904 }
5905
5906 /**
5907 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
5908 *
5909 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5910 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5911 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5912 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
5913 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5914 *
5915 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5916 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5917 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5918 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5919 */
5920 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5921 u32 iter_flags,
5922 void (*iterator)(void *data,
5923 u8 *mac,
5924 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5925 void *data);
5926
5927 /**
5928 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
5929 *
5930 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5931 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5932 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
5933 *
5934 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5935 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5936 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5937 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5938 */
5939 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5940 u32 iter_flags,
5941 void (*iterator)(void *data,
5942 u8 *mac,
5943 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5944 void *data);
5945
5946 /**
5947 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
5948 *
5949 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
5950 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
5951 * function for them.
5952 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5953 *
5954 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5955 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5956 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5957 */
5958 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5959 void (*iterator)(void *data,
5960 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
5961 void *data);
5962 /**
5963 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5964 *
5965 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
5966 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
5967 *
5968 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5969 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
5970 */
5971 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
5972
5973 /**
5974 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5975 *
5976 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
5977 * workqueue.
5978 *
5979 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5980 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
5981 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
5982 */
5983 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5984 struct delayed_work *dwork,
5985 unsigned long delay);
5986
5987 /**
5988 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
5989 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
5990 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5991 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
5992 *
5993 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
5994 *
5995 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5996 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5997 * will be managed by the mac80211.
5998 */
5999 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6000 u16 timeout);
6001
6002 /**
6003 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6004 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6005 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6006 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6007 *
6008 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6009 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6010 * from any context.
6011 */
6012 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6013 u16 tid);
6014
6015 /**
6016 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6017 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6018 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6019 *
6020 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6021 *
6022 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6023 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6024 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6025 */
6026 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6027
6028 /**
6029 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6030 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6031 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6032 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6033 *
6034 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6035 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6036 * can be called from any context.
6037 */
6038 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6039 u16 tid);
6040
6041 /**
6042 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6043 *
6044 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6045 * @addr: station's address
6046 *
6047 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6048 *
6049 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6050 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6051 */
6052 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6053 const u8 *addr);
6054
6055 /**
6056 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6057 *
6058 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6059 * @addr: remote station's address
6060 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6061 *
6062 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6063 *
6064 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6065 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6066 *
6067 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6068 * the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6069 * We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6070 * logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6071 * BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6072 * In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6073 * is not reliable.
6074 *
6075 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6076 */
6077 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6078 const u8 *addr,
6079 const u8 *localaddr);
6080
6081 /**
6082 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6083 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6084 * @addr: remote station's link address
6085 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6086 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6087 * may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6088 *
6089 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6090 */
6091 struct ieee80211_sta *
6092 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6093 const u8 *addr,
6094 const u8 *localaddr,
6095 unsigned int *link_id);
6096
6097 /**
6098 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6099 * @hw: the hardware
6100 * @pubsta: the station
6101 * @block: whether to block or unblock
6102 *
6103 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6104 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6105 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6106 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6107 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6108 *
6109 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6110 * manner.
6111 *
6112 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6113 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6114 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6115 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6116 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6117 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6118 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6119 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6120 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6121 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6122 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6123 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6124 * woke up while blocked or not.
6125 */
6126 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6127 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6128
6129 /**
6130 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6131 * @pubsta: the station
6132 *
6133 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6134 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6135 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6136 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6137 *
6138 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6139 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6140 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6141 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6142 *
6143 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6144 * driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6145 * you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6146 * and restore the _irqsafe version!
6147 */
6148 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6149
6150 /**
6151 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6152 * @pubsta: the station
6153 * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6154 *
6155 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6156 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6157 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6158 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6159 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6160 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6161 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6162 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6163 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6164 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6165 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6166 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6167 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6168 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6169 */
6170 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6171
6172 /**
6173 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6174 * @pubsta: the station
6175 *
6176 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6177 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6178 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6179 *
6180 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6181 * there is no need to call this function.
6182 */
6183 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6184
6185 /**
6186 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6187 *
6188 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6189 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6190 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6191 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6192 *
6193 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6194 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6195 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6196 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6197 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6198 * attempts.
6199 *
6200 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6201 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6202 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6203 * them to 0.
6204 *
6205 * @pubsta: the station
6206 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6207 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6208 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6209 */
6210 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6211 u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6212
6213 /**
6214 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6215 *
6216 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6217 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6218 *
6219 * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6220 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false.
6221 */
6222 bool
6223 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6224
6225 /**
6226 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6227 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6228 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6229 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6230 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6231 *
6232 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6233 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6234 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6235 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due
6236 * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few
6237 * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep.
6238 *
6239 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6240 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6241 * set_key callback.
6242 */
6243 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6244 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6245 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6246 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6247 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6248 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6249 void *data),
6250 void *iter_data);
6251
6252 /**
6253 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6254 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6255 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6256 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6257 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6258 *
6259 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6260 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6261 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6262 * in removal process will be skipped.
6263 *
6264 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6265 * and thus iter must be atomic.
6266 */
6267 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6268 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6269 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6270 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6271 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6272 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6273 void *data),
6274 void *iter_data);
6275
6276 /**
6277 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6278 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6279 * @iter: iterator function
6280 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6281 *
6282 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6283 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6284 * places while calling into the driver.
6285 *
6286 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6287 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6288 * removed.
6289 *
6290 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6291 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6292 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6293 * or not.
6294 */
6295 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6296 struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6297 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6298 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6299 void *data),
6300 void *iter_data);
6301
6302 /**
6303 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6304 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6305 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6306 *
6307 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6308 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6309 * information. This function must only be called from within the
6310 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6311 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6312 * %NULL.
6313 *
6314 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6315 */
6316 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6317 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6318
6319 /**
6320 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6321 *
6322 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6323 *
6324 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6325 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6326 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6327 */
6328 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6329
6330 /**
6331 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6332 *
6333 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6334 *
6335 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6336 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6337 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6338 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6339 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6340 *
6341 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6342 * without connection recovery attempts.
6343 */
6344 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6345
6346 /**
6347 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6348 *
6349 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6350 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6351 *
6352 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6353 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6354 */
6355 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6356
6357 /**
6358 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6359 *
6360 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6361 *
6362 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6363 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6364 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6365 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6366 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6367 *
6368 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6369 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6370 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6371 * disconnect normally later.
6372 *
6373 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6374 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6375 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6376 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6377 */
6378 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6379
6380 /**
6381 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6382 * hardware restart
6383 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6384 *
6385 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6386 * hardware restart.
6387 */
6388 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6389
6390 /**
6391 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6392 * rssi threshold triggered
6393 *
6394 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6395 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6396 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6397 * @gfp: context flags
6398 *
6399 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6400 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6401 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6402 */
6403 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6404 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6405 s32 rssi_level,
6406 gfp_t gfp);
6407
6408 /**
6409 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6410 *
6411 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6412 * @gfp: context flags
6413 */
6414 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6415
6416 /**
6417 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6418 *
6419 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6420 */
6421 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6422
6423 /**
6424 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6425 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6426 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6427 *
6428 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6429 * and wake up the suspended queues.
6430 */
6431 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success);
6432
6433 /**
6434 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6435 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6436 * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame.
6437 *
6438 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6439 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6440 * a deauth frame in this case.
6441 */
6442 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6443 bool block_tx);
6444
6445 /**
6446 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6447 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6448 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6449 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6450 *
6451 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6452 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6453 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6454 */
6455 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6456 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6457
6458 /**
6459 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6460 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6461 */
6462 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6463
6464 /**
6465 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6466 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6467 */
6468 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6469
6470 /**
6471 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6472 *
6473 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6474 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6475 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6476 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6477 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6478 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6479 *
6480 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6481 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6482 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6483 */
6484 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6485 const u8 *addr);
6486
6487 /**
6488 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6489 * @pubsta: station struct
6490 * @tid: the session's TID
6491 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6492 * assumed to be out of the window after the call
6493 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6494 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6495 *
6496 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6497 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6498 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6499 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6500 */
6501 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6502 u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6503 u16 received_mpdus);
6504
6505 /**
6506 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6507 *
6508 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6509 * buffer.
6510 *
6511 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6512 * @ra: the peer's destination address
6513 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6514 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6515 */
6516 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6517
6518 /**
6519 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6520 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6521 * @addr: station mac address
6522 * @tid: the rx tid
6523 */
6524 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6525 unsigned int tid);
6526
6527 /**
6528 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6529 *
6530 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6531 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6532 * reordering.
6533 *
6534 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6535 * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6536 *
6537 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6538 * @addr: station mac address
6539 * @tid: the rx tid
6540 */
ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6541 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6542 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6543 {
6544 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6545 return;
6546 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6547 }
6548
6549 /**
6550 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6551 *
6552 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6553 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6554 * reordering.
6555 *
6556 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6557 * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6558 *
6559 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6560 * @addr: station mac address
6561 * @tid: the rx tid
6562 */
ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6563 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6564 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6565 {
6566 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6567 return;
6568 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6569 }
6570
6571 /**
6572 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6573 *
6574 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6575 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6576 *
6577 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6578 *
6579 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6580 * @addr: station mac address
6581 * @tid: the rx tid
6582 */
6583 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6584 const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6585
6586 /* Rate control API */
6587
6588 /**
6589 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6590 *
6591 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6592 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6593 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6594 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6595 * to be filled in
6596 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6597 * which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6598 * used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6599 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6600 * RTS threshold
6601 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6602 * if the selected rate supports it
6603 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6604 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6605 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6606 */
6607 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6608 struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6609 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6610 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6611 struct sk_buff *skb;
6612 struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6613 bool rts, short_preamble;
6614 u32 rate_idx_mask;
6615 u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6616 bool bss;
6617 };
6618
6619 /**
6620 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6621 */
6622 enum rate_control_capabilities {
6623 /**
6624 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6625 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6626 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6627 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6628 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6629 */
6630 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6631 /**
6632 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6633 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6634 */
6635 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6636 };
6637
6638 struct rate_control_ops {
6639 unsigned long capa;
6640 const char *name;
6641 void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6642 void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6643 struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6644 void (*free)(void *priv);
6645
6646 void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6647 void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6648 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6649 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6650 void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6651 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6652 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6653 u32 changed);
6654 void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6655 void *priv_sta);
6656
6657 void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6658 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6659 void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6660 void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6661 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6662 struct sk_buff *skb);
6663 void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6664 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
6665
6666 void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
6667 struct dentry *dir);
6668
6669 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
6670 };
6671
rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,enum nl80211_band band,int index)6672 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6673 enum nl80211_band band,
6674 int index)
6675 {
6676 return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
6677 }
6678
6679 static inline s8
rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)6680 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6681 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6682 {
6683 int i;
6684
6685 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6686 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6687 return i;
6688
6689 /* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
6690 WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
6691
6692 /* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
6693 return 0;
6694 }
6695
6696 static inline
rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)6697 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6698 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6699 {
6700 unsigned int i;
6701
6702 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6703 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6704 return true;
6705 return false;
6706 }
6707
6708 /**
6709 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
6710 *
6711 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
6712 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
6713 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
6714 * the most recent rate control module decision.
6715 *
6716 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6717 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
6718 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
6719 */
6720 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6721 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
6722 struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
6723
6724 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6725 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6726
6727 static inline bool
conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6728 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6729 {
6730 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6731 }
6732
6733 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6734 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6735 {
6736 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6737 conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6738 }
6739
6740 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6741 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6742 {
6743 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6744 conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6745 }
6746
6747 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6748 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6749 {
6750 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
6751 }
6752
6753 static inline bool
conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6754 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6755 {
6756 return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
6757 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
6758 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
6759 }
6760
6761 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type,bool p2p)6762 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
6763 {
6764 if (p2p) {
6765 switch (type) {
6766 case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
6767 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
6768 case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
6769 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
6770 default:
6771 break;
6772 }
6773 }
6774 return type;
6775 }
6776
6777 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)6778 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6779 {
6780 return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
6781 }
6782
6783 /**
6784 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
6785 *
6786 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6787 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
6788 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
6789 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
6790 *
6791 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
6792 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
6793 * matching GroupId management frame.
6794 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
6795 */
6796 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6797 const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
6798
6799 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6800 int rssi_min_thold,
6801 int rssi_max_thold);
6802
6803 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6804
6805 /**
6806 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
6807 *
6808 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6809 *
6810 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
6811 *
6812 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
6813 * applicable.
6814 */
6815 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6816
6817 /**
6818 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
6819 * @vif: virtual interface
6820 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
6821 * @gfp: allocation flags
6822 *
6823 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
6824 */
6825 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6826 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
6827 gfp_t gfp);
6828
6829 /**
6830 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
6831 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6832 * @vif: virtual interface
6833 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
6834 * @band: the band to transmit on
6835 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
6836 *
6837 * Note: must be called under RCU lock
6838 */
6839 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6840 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
6841 int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
6842
6843 /**
6844 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
6845 * of injected frames.
6846 *
6847 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
6848 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
6849 * of the skb before calling this function.
6850 *
6851 * @skb: packet injected by userspace
6852 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
6853 */
6854 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
6855 struct net_device *dev);
6856
6857 /**
6858 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
6859 *
6860 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
6861 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
6862 *
6863 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
6864 *
6865 * private:
6866 *
6867 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
6868 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
6869 */
6870 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
6871 u32 next_tsf;
6872 bool has_next_tsf;
6873
6874 u8 absent;
6875
6876 u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6877 struct {
6878 u32 start;
6879 u32 duration;
6880 u32 interval;
6881 } desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6882 };
6883
6884 /**
6885 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
6886 *
6887 * @attr: P2P NoA IE
6888 * @data: NoA tracking data
6889 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6890 *
6891 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
6892 */
6893 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
6894 struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6895
6896 /**
6897 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
6898 *
6899 * @data: NoA tracking data
6900 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6901 */
6902 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6903
6904 /**
6905 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
6906 * @vif: virtual interface
6907 * @peer: the peer's destination address
6908 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
6909 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
6910 * @gfp: allocation flags
6911 *
6912 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
6913 */
6914 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
6915 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
6916 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
6917
6918 /**
6919 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
6920 *
6921 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
6922 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
6923 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
6924 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
6925 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
6926 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
6927 *
6928 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
6929 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
6930 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
6931 *
6932 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
6933 * @tid: the TID to reserve
6934 *
6935 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
6936 */
6937 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
6938
6939 /**
6940 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
6941 *
6942 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
6943 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
6944 * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
6945 *
6946 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
6947 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
6948 * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
6949 *
6950 * @sta: the station
6951 * @tid: the TID to unreserve
6952 */
6953 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
6954
6955 /**
6956 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
6957 *
6958 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6959 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
6960 * ieee80211_next_txq()
6961 *
6962 * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
6963 *
6964 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
6965 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
6966 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
6967 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
6968 * but for the duration of the frame handling.
6969 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
6970 * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
6971 *
6972 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
6973 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
6974 */
6975 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6976 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6977
6978 /**
6979 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
6980 * (in process context)
6981 *
6982 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
6983 * (internally disables bottom halves).
6984 *
6985 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6986 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
6987 * ieee80211_next_txq()
6988 */
ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)6989 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6990 struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
6991 {
6992 struct sk_buff *skb;
6993
6994 local_bh_disable();
6995 skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
6996 local_bh_enable();
6997
6998 return skb;
6999 }
7000
7001 /**
7002 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7003 *
7004 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7005 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7006 *
7007 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7008 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7009 */
7010 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7011 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7012
7013 /**
7014 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7015 *
7016 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7017 * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7018 *
7019 * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7020 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7021 * driver has finished scheduling it.
7022 */
7023 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7024
7025 /**
7026 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7027 *
7028 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7029 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7030 *
7031 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7032 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7033 */
7034 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7035
7036 /* (deprecated) */
ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u8 ac)7037 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7038 {
7039 }
7040
7041 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7042 struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7043
7044 /**
7045 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7046 *
7047 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7048 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7049 *
7050 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7051 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7052 *
7053 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7054 * this TXQ internally.
7055 */
7056 static inline void
ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7057 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7058 {
7059 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7060 }
7061
7062 /**
7063 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7064 *
7065 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7066 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7067 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7068 *
7069 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7070 * internally.
7071 */
7072 static inline void
ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq,bool force)7073 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7074 bool force)
7075 {
7076 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7077 }
7078
7079 /**
7080 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7081 *
7082 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7083 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7084 * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by
7085 * next_txq().
7086 *
7087 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7088 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7089 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7090 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7091 * again.
7092 *
7093 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7094 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7095 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7096 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7097 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7098 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7099 *
7100 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7101 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7102 */
7103 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7104 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7105
7106 /**
7107 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7108 *
7109 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7110 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7111 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7112 *
7113 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7114 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7115 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7116 */
7117 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7118 unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7119 unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7120
7121 /**
7122 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7123 *
7124 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7125 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7126 *
7127 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7128 * @inst_id: the local instance id
7129 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7130 * @gfp: allocation flags
7131 */
7132 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7133 u8 inst_id,
7134 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7135 gfp_t gfp);
7136
7137 /**
7138 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7139 *
7140 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7141 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7142 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7143 *
7144 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7145 * @match: match event information
7146 * @gfp: allocation flags
7147 */
7148 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7149 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7150 gfp_t gfp);
7151
7152 /**
7153 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7154 *
7155 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7156 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7157 *
7158 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7159 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7160 * information.
7161 * @len: frame length in bytes
7162 */
7163 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7164 struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7165 int len);
7166
7167 /**
7168 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7169 *
7170 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7171 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7172 *
7173 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7174 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7175 * @len: frame length in bytes
7176 */
7177 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7178 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7179 int len);
7180 /**
7181 * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading.
7182 *
7183 * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3
7184 * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the
7185 * hardware or firmware.
7186 *
7187 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7188 * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off
7189 */
7190 bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable);
7191
7192 /**
7193 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7194 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7195 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7196 *
7197 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7198 *
7199 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7200 */
7201 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7202 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7203
7204 /**
7205 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7206 * probe response template.
7207 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7208 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7209 *
7210 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7211 *
7212 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7213 */
7214 struct sk_buff *
7215 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7216 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7217
7218 /**
7219 * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7220 * collision.
7221 *
7222 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7223 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7224 * aware of.
7225 * @gfp: allocation flags
7226 */
7227 void
7228 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7229 u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp);
7230
7231 /**
7232 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7233 *
7234 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7235 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7236 *
7237 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7238 */
ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff * skb)7239 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7240 {
7241 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7242 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7243
7244 return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7245 ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7246 }
7247
7248 /**
7249 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7250 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7251 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7252 *
7253 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7254 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7255 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7256 *
7257 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7258 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7259 * a sequence of calls like
7260 * - change_vif_links(0x11)
7261 * - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7262 * - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7263 * (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7264 * - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7265 * - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7266 * - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7267 * - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7268 * - change_vif_links(0x10)
7269 *
7270 * Note: This function acquires some mac80211 locks and must not
7271 * be called with any driver locks held that could cause a
7272 * lock dependency inversion. Best call it without locks.
7273 */
7274 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7275
7276 /**
7277 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7278 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7279 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7280 *
7281 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7282 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7283 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7284 * completed after it returns.
7285 */
7286 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7287 u16 active_links);
7288
7289 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7290